WO2024109468A1 - 一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质 - Google Patents

一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质 Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2024109468A1
WO2024109468A1 PCT/CN2023/127900 CN2023127900W WO2024109468A1 WO 2024109468 A1 WO2024109468 A1 WO 2024109468A1 CN 2023127900 W CN2023127900 W CN 2023127900W WO 2024109468 A1 WO2024109468 A1 WO 2024109468A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
frame
operating mode
field
bandwidth
operation mode
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/CN2023/127900
Other languages
English (en)
French (fr)
Inventor
阮卫
马云思
Original Assignee
华为技术有限公司
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by 华为技术有限公司 filed Critical 华为技术有限公司
Publication of WO2024109468A1 publication Critical patent/WO2024109468A1/zh

Links

Classifications

    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W24/00Supervisory, monitoring or testing arrangements
    • H04W24/02Arrangements for optimising operational condition
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W76/00Connection management
    • H04W76/10Connection setup

Definitions

  • the present application relates to the field of wireless communication technology, and in particular to a communication method, device and computer-readable storage medium.
  • the 802.11ax standard introduces the operating mode indication (OMI) mechanism.
  • OMI operating mode indication
  • STA is the OMI initiator and access point (AP) is the OMI responder.
  • STA can send data frames or control frames containing the operating mode (OM) control field to AP to enable STA to dynamically switch single-user/multi-user operating mode, channel bandwidth, maximum number of received spatial streams, etc.
  • the existing OMI mechanism only supports STA to initiate OM negotiation, resulting in poor flexibility in operating mode switching and low efficiency in service transmission. Therefore, how to improve the efficiency of service transmission is an urgent problem to be solved.
  • the embodiments of the present application provide a communication method, device, and computer-readable storage medium, which can improve the efficiency of business transmission.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication method, which can be applied to a first device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the first device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the first device.
  • the following description is made by taking the execution subject as the first device as an example.
  • the communication method includes: a first device and a second device establish a wireless communication link, the first device operates in a first operating mode; the first device switches from the first operating mode to a second operating mode to communicate with the second device.
  • the first device can switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode and communicate with the second device. By switching the operating mode of the first device, the efficiency of service transmission can be improved.
  • the first device when a first condition is met, switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode, and the first condition includes one or more of the following: the first device changes from a listening state to a data transmission state; or the amount of data to be transmitted between the first device and the second device changes from less than or equal to a first threshold to greater than the first threshold.
  • the first device when the first device changes from a listening state to a data transmission state; or when the amount of data to be transmitted between the first device and the second device changes from less than or equal to a first threshold to greater than the first threshold, the first device can switch from a first operating mode to a second operating mode, thereby improving the efficiency of service transmission.
  • the first operating mode corresponds to a first bandwidth
  • the second operating mode corresponds to a second bandwidth
  • different operating modes may correspond to different bandwidths.
  • the second device operates in a third operating mode, and the third operating mode corresponds to a third bandwidth.
  • the first bandwidth is smaller than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the second bandwidth is smaller than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode, including: the first device generates a first frame, the first frame includes a first field, and the first field contains an operating mode parameter; the first device sends the first frame to the second device; the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode.
  • the first device can generate and send a first frame containing operating mode parameters to the second device, so that the first device can actively initiate operating mode negotiation, or respond to the operating mode negotiation initiated by the second device through the first frame, thereby improving the flexibility of operating mode switching and further improving the efficiency of service transmission.
  • the first field includes an indication of operation mode switching duration.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the communication method further includes: the first device receiving a second frame from the second device, the second frame including a second field, the second frame being used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field being used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation to the first device.
  • the second device can The first device can actively initiate OM negotiation with the first device based on the amount of data to be transmitted, latency requirements, channel status, and other information of the service, thereby improving the flexibility of the operation mode switching negotiation.
  • the first device does not need to perceive the amount of data transmitted on the second device side.
  • the first device only needs to respond to the second frame from the second device to achieve the operation mode switching, thereby improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device and reducing the delay of the operation mode switching.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the method further includes: the first device sends a seventh frame to the second device before a current transmission opportunity (TXOP), the seventh frame being used to indicate a switching time for the first device to switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode; and the first device receives an eighth frame from the second device, the eighth frame being used to respond to the seventh frame.
  • TXOP current transmission opportunity
  • the first device can negotiate the switching time of the first device from the first operating mode to the second operating mode through the seventh frame and the eighth frame before the TXOP.
  • the first device completes the operating mode switch, it is no longer necessary to send the third frame to indicate the completion of the switch, which saves signaling overhead and can improve the transmission data efficiency within the TXOP.
  • the method further includes: the first device receiving a fifth frame from the second device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the first device sending the first frame to the second device includes:
  • the first device evaluates the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side based on the TXOP duration in the fifth frame. When the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side is greater than or equal to a fourth threshold, the first device sends the first frame to the second device within the current TXOP.
  • the first device after the first device receives the fifth frame from the second device, it can evaluate the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side according to the fifth frame, and thus independently decide whether to initiate OM negotiation.
  • the first device can implement operation mode switching by actively initiating OM negotiation to the second device, thereby improving the flexibility of operation mode switching negotiation, improving the timeliness of operation mode switching of the first device, and reducing the delay of operation mode switching.
  • the first device sending the first frame to the second device includes:
  • the first device When the time indicated by the TXOP duration in the fifth frame exceeds a preset threshold, the first device sends the first frame to the second device in the current TXOP.
  • the first device can actively initiate OM negotiation to the second device within a TXOP to implement operation mode switching, thereby improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device and reducing the delay of the operation mode switching.
  • the method further includes: the first device sending a sixth frame to the second device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the first device receives the second frame from the second device, and after completing the operating mode switching according to the second frame, it can send a sixth frame to the second device, such as a CTS frame, to request the second device to transmit data to the first device, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • a sixth frame such as a CTS frame
  • the method further includes: the first device receives a ninth frame from the second device, and the ninth frame is used by the second device to transmit data to one or more first devices; the first device sends a tenth frame to the second device, and the tenth frame is used to respond to the ninth frame.
  • the first device or the second device can actively initiate operation mode negotiation to achieve operation mode switching, thereby improving the flexibility of operation mode switching negotiation, improving the timeliness of operation mode switching of the first device, and reducing the delay of operation mode switching.
  • the method further includes: during a period in which the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode, the first device receives data from the second device.
  • the first device and the second device send and receive data, which can improve the air interface utilization and avoid the problem of other users occupying the channel due to the long switching time.
  • the communication method further includes: the first device sending a third frame to the second device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the first device can send a third frame, such as an OMI ACK frame, to the second device after the operation mode switch is completed, to indicate that the operation mode switch is completed, thereby achieving efficient and reliable service transmission, and solving the problem that the first device cannot notify the second device of the switching status or switching completion time of the current operation mode, and avoiding the second device sending data in advance, resulting in frequent retransmission and packet loss of data packets, resulting in reduced throughput and increased transmission delay.
  • a third frame such as an OMI ACK frame
  • the first device sending the third frame to the second device includes: when the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field is a first value, the first device sending the third frame to the second device after completing the operation mode switching.
  • the third frame when the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field is a first value, the first device sending the third frame to the second device after completing the operation mode switching.
  • the operating mode switching duration indication subfield included in the first field in the first frame when the operating mode switching duration indication subfield included in the first field in the first frame is set to 0, it indicates that the first field does not carry the operating mode switching duration of the first device.
  • the first device can send a third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching to notify the second device to send data, thereby achieving efficient and reliable service transmission.
  • the first device sending the third frame to the second device includes: when the operating mode switching duration of the first device is greater than the time indicated by the operating mode switching duration in the first field, the first device sends the third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching.
  • the operating mode switching time of the first device is relatively long, and the operating mode switching cannot be completed within the time indicated by the operating mode switching duration in the first field.
  • the first device can send a third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching, indicating that the operating mode switching has been completed, so as to notify the second device to send data, thereby achieving efficient and reliable service transmission.
  • the first device sending the third frame to the second device includes: the first device selecting an original signal bandwidth or a switched signal bandwidth to send the third frame to the second device.
  • the first device can select the original signal bandwidth or the switched signal bandwidth to send the third frame to the second device, which can reduce the co-channel interference of the uplink signal on the first device side to the adjacent user.
  • the first frame is a clear to send (CTS) frame or a trigger frame.
  • CTS clear to send
  • the second frame is a request to send (RTS) frame or a trigger frame.
  • RTS request to send
  • the third frame is an acknowledgement (ACK) frame.
  • ACK acknowledgement
  • the fifth frame is an RTS frame.
  • the communication method further includes: the first device pre-stores physical (PHY) layer module calibration data under different operating modes; the first device selects the corresponding PHY layer module calibration data according to the first field and configures the PHY layer register.
  • PHY physical
  • the time for switching the operating mode can be reduced and the delay can be reduced.
  • the first device pre-stores PHY layer module calibration data under different operating modes, including: the first device pre-stores PHY layer calibration data of a first bandwidth operating mode, and the first bandwidth is a bandwidth greater than or equal to a first threshold; the communication method also includes: the first device uses a signal bandwidth less than the first bandwidth to send and receive signals after channel switching.
  • the first device may pre-store PHY layer module calibration data of the first bandwidth operation mode, thereby simplifying the complexity of implementation.
  • the communication method further includes: the first device receiving a fourth frame from the second device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate an end of the TXOP.
  • the second device after the second device sends data to the first device, it can send a fourth frame to end the current TXOP in advance, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication method, which can be applied to a second device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the second device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • the following description is made by taking the execution subject as the second device as an example.
  • the communication method includes: a second device and a first device establish a wireless communication link, the first device operates in a first operating mode; the second device communicates with the first device based on the second operating mode.
  • the first device can switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode and communicate with the second device.
  • the efficiency of service transmission can be improved by the second device communicating with the first device in the switched operating mode.
  • the executor of the second aspect can be the second device
  • the specific content of the second aspect corresponds to the content of the first aspect
  • the corresponding features of the second aspect and the beneficial effects achieved can refer to the description of the first aspect, and in order to avoid repetition, the detailed description is appropriately omitted here.
  • the second device when a first condition is met, communicates with the first device based on a second operating mode, and the first condition includes one or more of the following: the first device changes from a listening state to a data transmission state; or the amount of data to be transmitted between the first device and the second device changes from less than or equal to a first threshold to greater than the first threshold.
  • the first operating mode corresponds to a first bandwidth
  • the second operating mode corresponds to a second bandwidth
  • the second device operates in a third operating mode, and the third operating mode corresponds to a third bandwidth.
  • the first bandwidth is smaller than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the second bandwidth is smaller than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the communication method further includes: the second device receiving a first frame from the first device, the first The frame includes a first field containing an operating mode parameter.
  • the first field includes an indication of operation mode switching duration.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the communication method further includes: the second device sending a second frame to the first device, the second frame including a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the second device sending the second frame to the first device includes: when the amount of data to be transmitted of the second device is greater than or equal to a second threshold or the required transmission time of the data to be transmitted is greater than or equal to a third threshold, the second device sending the second frame to the first device.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation with the first device based on the amount of data to be transmitted, latency requirements, channel status and other information of its own business, thereby improving the flexibility of the operation mode switching negotiation.
  • the first device does not need to perceive the amount of data transmitted on the second device side.
  • the first device only needs to respond to the second frame from the second device to achieve the operation mode switching, thereby improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device and reducing the delay of the operation mode switching.
  • the method further includes: the second device receives a seventh frame from the first device before the current TXOP, and the seventh frame is used to indicate a switching time for the first device to switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode; and the second device sends an eighth frame to the first device, and the eighth frame is used to respond to the seventh frame.
  • the method further includes: the second device sending a fifth frame to the first device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the method further includes: the second device sending a sixth frame to the first device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the method further includes: the second device sends a ninth frame to the first device, and the ninth frame is used by the second device to transmit data to one or more first devices; the second device receives a tenth frame from the first device, and the tenth frame is used to respond to the ninth frame.
  • the method further includes: the second device sending data to the one or more first devices when the second device receives the first frame from the one or more first devices or does not receive the first frame from the one or more first devices within a preset time.
  • the first device in a multi-user scenario, can actively initiate operating mode negotiation by sending a first frame to the second device.
  • the second device receives the first frame of at least one first device or fails to receive the first frame within a preset time, the second device can still send data to the first device based on the original operating mode until the first device completes the operating mode switching.
  • the second device can send data to the first device based on the switched operating mode.
  • the method further includes: during a period in which the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode, the second device sends data to the first device.
  • the communication method further includes: the second device receiving a third frame from the first device, wherein the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the communication method further includes: after the second device receives the third frame from the first device, sending data to the first device.
  • the second device can determine the time to send data to the first device based on the receipt of the third frame, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • the communication method further includes: when the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field is a second value, the second device sends data to the first device after a time indicated by the operation mode switching duration.
  • the second device can determine the time to send data to the first device according to the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the fifth frame is an RTS frame.
  • the communication method further includes: the second device sending a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate an end of the TXOP.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication method, which can be applied to a first device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the first device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the first device.
  • the following description is made by taking the execution subject as the first device as an example.
  • the communication method includes: a first device generates a first frame, the first frame includes a first field, and the first field includes an operating mode parameter; the first device sends the first frame to a second device.
  • the first device can generate and send a first frame containing operating mode parameters to the second device, so that the first device can actively initiate operating mode negotiation, or respond to the operating mode negotiation initiated by the second device through the first frame, thereby improving the flexibility of operating mode switching.
  • the first field includes an indication of operation mode switching duration.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the communication method further includes:
  • the first device receives a second frame from the second device, the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation with the first device.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation with the first device based on the amount of data to be transmitted, latency requirements, channel status and other information of its own business, thereby improving the flexibility of operation mode switching negotiation.
  • the first device does not need to perceive the amount of data transmitted on the second device side. The first device only needs to respond to the second frame from the second device to achieve operation mode switching, thereby improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device and reducing the latency of the operation mode switching.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the method further includes:
  • the first device receives a fifth frame from the second device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the first device sending the first frame to the second device includes:
  • the first device evaluates the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side based on the fifth frame, and when the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side is greater than or equal to a fourth threshold, the first device sends the first frame to the second device within a current transmission opportunity (TXOP).
  • TXOP current transmission opportunity
  • the first device after the first device receives the fifth frame from the second device, it can evaluate the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side according to the fifth frame, and thus independently decide whether to initiate OM negotiation.
  • the first device can implement operation mode switching by actively initiating OM negotiation to the second device, thereby improving the flexibility of operation mode switching negotiation, improving the timeliness of operation mode switching of the first device, and reducing the delay of operation mode switching.
  • the first device sending the first frame to the second device includes: when the time indicated by the TXOP duration in the fifth frame exceeds a preset threshold, the first device sending the first frame to the second device within the current TXOP.
  • the first device can actively initiate OM negotiation to the second device within a TXOP to implement operation mode switching, thereby improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device and reducing the delay of the operation mode switching.
  • the communication method further includes: the first device sending a third frame to the second device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the first device can send a third frame, such as an OMI ACK frame, to the second device after the operation mode switch is completed, to indicate that the operation mode switch is completed, thereby achieving efficient and reliable service transmission, and solving the problem that the first device cannot notify the second device of the switching status or switching completion time of the current operation mode, and avoiding the second device sending data in advance, resulting in frequent retransmission and packet loss of data packets, resulting in reduced throughput and increased transmission delay.
  • a third frame such as an OMI ACK frame
  • the first device sending the third frame to the second device includes: when the operating mode switching duration indication in the first field is a first numerical value, the first device sending the third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching.
  • the operating mode switching duration indication subfield included in the first field in the first frame when the operating mode switching duration indication subfield included in the first field in the first frame is set to 0, it indicates that the first field does not carry the operating mode switching duration of the first device.
  • the first device can send a third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching to notify the second device to send data, thereby achieving efficient and reliable service transmission.
  • the first device sending the third frame to the second device includes: when the operating mode switching duration of the first device is greater than the time indicated by the operating mode switching duration in the first field, the first device sends the third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching.
  • the first device operating mode switching time is relatively long.
  • the method uses the time indicated by the operating mode switching duration in the first field to complete the operating mode switching.
  • the first device can send a third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching, indicating that the operating mode switching has been completed, so as to notify the second device to send data, thereby achieving efficient and reliable service transmission.
  • the first device sending the third frame to the second device includes: the first device selecting an original signal bandwidth or a switched signal bandwidth to send the third frame to the second device.
  • the first device can select the original signal bandwidth or the switched signal bandwidth to send the third frame to the second device, which can reduce the co-channel interference of the uplink signal on the first device side to the adjacent user.
  • the first frame is a clear to send (CTS) frame or a trigger frame.
  • CTS clear to send
  • the second frame is a request to send (RTS) frame or a trigger frame.
  • RTS request to send
  • the third frame is an acknowledgement (ACK) frame.
  • ACK acknowledgement
  • the fifth frame is an RTS frame.
  • the communication method further includes: the first device pre-stores physical (PHY) layer module calibration data under different operating modes; the first device selects the corresponding PHY layer module calibration data according to the first field and configures the PHY layer register.
  • PHY physical
  • the time for switching the operating mode can be reduced and the delay can be reduced.
  • the first device pre-stores PHY layer module calibration data under different operating modes, including: the first device pre-stores PHY layer calibration data of a first bandwidth operating mode, and the first bandwidth is a bandwidth greater than or equal to a first threshold; the communication method also includes: the first device uses a signal bandwidth less than the first bandwidth to send and receive signals after channel switching.
  • the first device may pre-store PHY layer module calibration data of the first bandwidth operation mode, thereby simplifying the complexity of implementation.
  • the communication method further includes: the first device receiving a fourth frame from the second device, the fourth frame being used to indicate an end of the TXOP.
  • the second device after the second device sends data to the first device, it can send a fourth frame to end the current TXOP in advance, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication method, which can be applied to a second device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the second device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • the following description is made by taking the execution subject as the second device as an example.
  • the communication method includes: the second device receives a first frame from the first device, the first frame includes a first field, and the first field includes an operating mode parameter.
  • the second device can receive the first frame containing the operating mode parameters from the first device, so that the first device can actively initiate the operating mode negotiation, or respond to the operating mode negotiation initiated by the second device through the first frame, thereby improving the flexibility of the operating mode switching.
  • the executor of the fourth aspect can be the second device, the specific content of the second aspect corresponds to the content of the third aspect, the corresponding features of the fourth aspect and the beneficial effects achieved can refer to the description of the third aspect. To avoid repetition, the detailed description is appropriately omitted here.
  • the first field includes an indication of operation mode switching duration.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the communication method further includes:
  • the second device generates a second frame, the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters;
  • the second device sends the second frame to the first device.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the second device sending the second frame to the first device includes:
  • the second device When the amount of data to be transmitted of the second device is greater than or equal to a second threshold or the required transmission time of the data to be transmitted is greater than or equal to a third threshold, the second device sends the second frame to the first device.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation with the first device based on the amount of data to be transmitted, latency requirements, channel status and other information of its own business, thereby improving the flexibility of the operation mode switching negotiation.
  • the first device does not need to perceive the amount of data transmitted on the second device side.
  • the first device only needs to respond to the second frame from the second device to achieve the operation mode switching, thereby improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device and reducing the delay of the operation mode switching.
  • the method further includes:
  • the second device sends a fifth frame to the first device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the communication method further includes:
  • the second device receives a third frame from the first device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the communication method further includes: after the second device receives the third frame from the first device, sending data to the first device.
  • the second device can determine the time to send data to the first device based on the receipt of the third frame, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • the communication method further includes: when the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field is a second value, the second device sends data to the first device after a time indicated by the operation mode switching duration.
  • the second device can determine the time to send data to the first device according to the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the fifth frame is an RTS frame.
  • the communication method further includes: the second device sending a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of a current TXOP.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication method, which can be applied to a first device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the first device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the first device.
  • the following description is made by taking the execution subject as the first device as an example.
  • the communication method includes:
  • the first device receives a second frame from the second device, the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the first device may receive a second frame for initiating operation mode negotiation from the second device, so that the second device actively initiates operation mode negotiation, thereby improving the flexibility of operation mode switching.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the method further includes: the first device generating a first frame, the first frame including a first field, the first field including an operating mode parameter; and the first device sending the first frame to the second device.
  • the first device after receiving the second frame from the second device, can send the first frame to the second device in response to the second frame, that is, in response to the OM negotiation actively initiated by the second device, thereby improving the flexibility of operating mode switching.
  • the first field includes an indication of operation mode switching duration.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the method further includes:
  • the first device sends a sixth frame to the second device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the first device when it receives the second frame from the second device, it can send a sixth frame, such as a CTS frame, to the second device to request the second device to transmit data to the first device, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • a sixth frame such as a CTS frame
  • the communication method further includes: the first device sending a third frame to the second device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the first device after completing the operating mode switch according to the second frame, can send a third frame to the second device, such as an ACK frame, to indicate that the operating mode switch is completed, thereby achieving efficient and reliable service transmission, and solving the problem that the first device cannot notify the second device of the switching status or switching completion time of the current operating mode, and avoiding the second device sending data in advance, resulting in frequent retransmission and packet loss of data packets, resulting in reduced throughput and increased transmission delay.
  • the second device such as an ACK frame
  • the first device sending the third frame to the second device includes: when the operating mode switching duration indication in the first field is a first value, the first device sending the third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching.
  • the operating mode switching duration indication subfield included in the first field in the first frame when the operating mode switching duration indication subfield included in the first field in the first frame is set to 0, it indicates that the first field does not carry the operating mode switching duration of the first device.
  • the first device can send a third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching to notify the second device to send data, thereby achieving efficient and reliable service transmission.
  • the first device sending the third frame to the second device includes: when the operating mode switching duration of the first device is greater than the time indicated by the operating mode switching duration in the first field, the first device sends the third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching.
  • the operating mode switching time of the first device is relatively long, and the operating mode switching cannot be completed within the time indicated by the operating mode switching duration in the first field.
  • the first device can send a third frame to the second device after completing the operating mode switching, indicating that the operating mode switching has been completed, so as to notify the second device to send data, thereby achieving efficient and reliable service transmission.
  • the first device sending the third frame to the second device includes: the first device selecting an original signal bandwidth or a switched signal bandwidth to send the third frame to the second device.
  • the first device can select the original signal bandwidth or the switched signal bandwidth to send the third frame to the second device, which can reduce the co-channel interference of the uplink signal on the first device side to the adjacent user.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the sixth frame is a CTS frame.
  • the communication method further includes: the first device receiving a fourth frame from the second device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate an end of the TXOP.
  • the second device after the second device sends data to the first device, it can send a fourth frame to end the current TXOP in advance, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication method, which can be applied to a second device, or to a module (for example, a chip or a processor) in the second device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • the following description is given by taking the execution subject as the second device as an example.
  • the communication method includes: the second device generates a second frame, the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate an operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend an operation mode parameter; the second device sends the second frame to the first device.
  • the second device may actively initiate operation mode negotiation to the first device through the second frame, thereby improving the flexibility of operation mode switching negotiation.
  • the executor of the sixth aspect can be the second device
  • the specific content of the sixth aspect corresponds to the content of the fifth aspect
  • the corresponding features of the sixth aspect and the beneficial effects achieved can refer to the description of the fifth aspect. To avoid repetition, the detailed description is appropriately omitted here.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the second device sending the second frame to the first device includes:
  • the second device When the amount of data to be transmitted of the second device is greater than or equal to a second threshold or the required transmission time of the data to be transmitted is greater than or equal to a third threshold, the second device sends the second frame to the first device.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation with the first device based on the amount of data to be transmitted, latency requirements, channel status and other information of its own business, thereby improving the flexibility of the operation mode switching negotiation.
  • the first device does not need to perceive the amount of data transmitted on the second device side.
  • the first device only needs to respond to the second frame from the second device to achieve the operation mode switching, thereby improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device and reducing the delay of the operation mode switching.
  • the method further includes:
  • the second device receives a first frame from the first device, the first frame comprising a first field, the first field comprising an operating mode parameter.
  • the first device after receiving the second frame from the second device, can send the first frame to the second device in response to the second frame, that is, in response to the OM negotiation actively initiated by the second device, thereby improving the flexibility of operating mode switching.
  • the first field includes an indication of operation mode switching duration.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the method further includes:
  • the second device receives a sixth frame from the first device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the communication method further includes:
  • the second device receives a third frame from the first device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the communication method further includes: after the second device receives the third frame from the first device, Send data to the first device.
  • the second device can determine the time to send data to the first device based on the receipt of the third frame, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • the communication method further includes: when the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field is a second value, the second device sends data to the first device after a time indicated by the operation mode switching duration.
  • the second device can determine the time to send data to the first device according to the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • the communication method further includes: after the second device receives the sixth frame from the first device, sending data to the first device.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the sixth frame is a CTS frame.
  • the communication method further includes: the second device sending a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate an end of the TXOP.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication device.
  • the communication device can be applied to the first device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the first device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the first device.
  • a module e.g., a chip or a processor
  • the beneficial effects can be found in the description of the first aspect, which will not be repeated here.
  • the communication device has the function of implementing the behavior in the method example of the first aspect above.
  • the function can be implemented by hardware, or by hardware executing corresponding software implementation.
  • the hardware or software includes one or more modules corresponding to the above functions.
  • the communication device includes:
  • An establishing unit configured to establish a wireless communication link with a second device, wherein the first device operates in a first operating mode
  • a switching unit configured to switch from the first operating mode to a second operating mode
  • a transceiver unit used for communicating with the second device.
  • the switching unit switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode when a first condition is met, and the first condition includes one or more of the following: the first device changes from a listening state to a data transmission state; or the amount of data to be transmitted between the first device and the second device changes from less than or equal to a first threshold to greater than the first threshold.
  • the first operating mode corresponds to a first bandwidth
  • the second operating mode corresponds to a second bandwidth
  • the second device operates in a third operating mode, and the third operating mode corresponds to a third bandwidth.
  • the first bandwidth is smaller than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the second bandwidth is smaller than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the switching unit switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode, specifically for: generating a first frame, the first frame including a first field, the first field including an operating mode parameter; sending the first frame to the second device; and switching from the first operating mode to the second operating mode.
  • the first field includes an indication of operation mode switching duration.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to receive a second frame from the second device, the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to send a seventh frame to the second device before the current TXOP, where the seventh frame is used to indicate a switching time for the first device to switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode;
  • the transceiver unit is further used to receive an eighth frame from the second device, where the eighth frame is used to respond to the seventh frame.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to receive a fifth frame from the second device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the transceiver unit sends a first frame to the second device, which is specifically used to: evaluate the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side based on the TXOP duration in the fifth frame, and when the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side is greater than or equal to a fourth threshold, send the first frame to the second device within the current TXOP.
  • the transceiver unit sends the first frame to the second device, specifically configured to: in the TXOP When the time indicated by the duration exceeds a preset threshold, the first frame is sent to the second device in the current TXOP.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to send a sixth frame to the second device, and the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to receive a ninth frame from the second device, where the ninth frame is used for the second device to transmit data to one or more first devices;
  • the transceiver unit is further configured to send a tenth frame to the second device, where the tenth frame is used to respond to the ninth frame.
  • the transceiver unit is further configured to receive data from the second device during a period in which the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to send a third frame to the second device, and the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the transceiver unit sends a third frame to the second device, specifically for: when the operating mode switching duration indication in the first field is a first value, after completing the operating mode switching, sending the third frame to the second device.
  • the transceiver unit sends a third frame to the second device, specifically for: when the operating mode switching duration of the first device is greater than the time indicated by the operating mode switching duration in the first field, after completing the operating mode switching, sending the third frame to the second device.
  • the transceiver unit sends the third frame to the second device, specifically for: selecting the original signal bandwidth or the switched signal bandwidth to send the third frame to the second device.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is a request to send RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the fifth frame is an RTS frame.
  • the communication device further includes:
  • a processing unit used for pre-storing PHY layer module calibration data in different operation modes
  • the corresponding PHY layer module calibration data is selected according to the first field, and the PHY layer register is configured.
  • the processing unit pre-stores PHY layer module calibration data in different operation modes, specifically for: pre-storing PHY layer calibration data of a first bandwidth operation mode, where the first bandwidth is a bandwidth greater than or equal to a first threshold;
  • the transceiver unit is further configured to transmit and receive signals using a signal bandwidth smaller than the first bandwidth after channel switching.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to receive a fourth frame from the second device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate an end of the TXOP.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication device.
  • the communication device can be applied to the second device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the second device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • the beneficial effects can be found in the description of the second aspect, which will not be repeated here.
  • the communication device has the function of implementing the behavior in the method example of the second aspect.
  • the function can be implemented by hardware, or by hardware executing corresponding software.
  • the hardware or software includes one or more modules corresponding to the above functions.
  • the communication device includes:
  • An establishing unit configured to establish a wireless communication link with a first device, wherein the first device operates in a first operating mode
  • a transceiver unit is used to communicate with the first device based on the second operating mode.
  • the transceiver unit communicates with the first device based on the second operating mode, and the first condition includes one or more of the following: the first device changes from a listening state to a data transmission state; or the amount of data to be transmitted between the first device and the second device changes from less than or equal to a first threshold to greater than the first threshold.
  • the first operating mode corresponds to a first bandwidth
  • the second operating mode corresponds to a second bandwidth
  • the second device operates in a third operating mode, and the third operating mode corresponds to a third bandwidth.
  • the first bandwidth is smaller than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the second bandwidth is smaller than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the transceiver unit is further configured to receive a first frame from the first device, where the first frame includes a first field, and the first field includes an operating mode parameter.
  • the first field includes an indication of operation mode switching duration.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to send a second frame to the first device, the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the transceiver unit sends a second frame to the first device, specifically for: sending the second frame to the first device when the amount of data to be transmitted of the second device is greater than or equal to a second threshold or the required transmission time of the data to be transmitted is greater than or equal to a third threshold.
  • the transceiver unit is further used for:
  • the seventh frame being used to indicate a switching time when the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode;
  • An eighth frame is sent to the first device, where the eighth frame is used to respond to the seventh frame.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to send a fifth frame to the first device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to send a sixth frame to the first device, and the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the transceiver unit is further used for:
  • a tenth frame is received from the first device, where the tenth frame is used to respond to the ninth frame.
  • the transceiver unit is further configured to send data to the one or more first devices when a first frame is received from the one or more first devices or when a first frame is not received from the one or more first devices within a preset time.
  • the transceiver unit is further configured to send data to the first device during a period in which the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to receive a third frame from the first device, and the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the transceiver unit is further configured to send data to the first device after receiving the third frame from the first device.
  • the transceiver unit is further configured to send data to the first device after a time indicated by the operating mode switching duration when the operating mode switching duration in the first field indicates a second value.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the fifth frame is an RTS frame.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to send a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the TXOP.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication device.
  • the communication device can be applied to the first device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the first device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the first device.
  • a module e.g., a chip or a processor
  • the beneficial effects can be found in the description of the third aspect, which will not be repeated here.
  • the communication device has the function of implementing the behavior in the method example of the third aspect above.
  • the function can be implemented by hardware, or by hardware executing corresponding software implementation.
  • the hardware or software includes one or more modules corresponding to the above functions.
  • the communication device includes:
  • a generating unit configured to generate a first frame, wherein the first frame comprises a first field, and the first field comprises an operation mode parameter;
  • a transceiver unit is used to send the first frame to the second device.
  • the first field includes an indication of the duration of the operation mode switch.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the communication device further includes:
  • the transceiver unit is used to receive a second frame from the second device, the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to: receive a fifth frame from the second device, the fifth frame being used to request the The second device transmits data to the first device;
  • the transceiver unit sends the first frame to the second device, specifically for:
  • the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side is evaluated according to the fifth frame, and when the TXOP is greater than or equal to a fourth threshold, the first frame is sent to the second device in the current TXOP.
  • the transceiver unit sends the first frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the first frame is sent to the second device in the current TXOP.
  • the transceiver unit is further used to: send a third frame to the second device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the transceiver unit sends the third frame to the second device, specifically for:
  • the third frame is sent to the second device.
  • the transceiver unit sends the third frame to the second device, specifically for:
  • the third frame is sent to the second device after the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the transceiver unit sends the third frame to the second device, specifically for:
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the fifth frame is an RTS frame.
  • the communication device further includes:
  • the processing unit is used to pre-store PHY layer module calibration data in different operating modes
  • the processing unit is further used to select corresponding PHY layer module calibration data according to the first field and configure the PHY layer register.
  • the processing unit pre-stores PHY layer module calibration data in different operation modes, specifically for: pre-storing PHY layer calibration data of a first bandwidth operation mode, where the first bandwidth is a bandwidth greater than or equal to a first threshold;
  • the transceiver unit is further configured to transmit and receive signals using a signal bandwidth smaller than the first bandwidth after channel switching.
  • the transceiver unit is further configured to receive a fourth frame from the second device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate an end of the TXOP.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication device.
  • the communication device can be applied to the second device, or to a module (for example, a chip or a processor) in the second device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • the beneficial effects can be found in the description of the fourth aspect, which will not be repeated here.
  • the communication device has the function of implementing the behavior in the method example of the fourth aspect.
  • the function can be implemented by hardware, or by executing the corresponding software implementation by hardware.
  • the hardware or software includes one or more modules corresponding to the above functions.
  • the communication device includes:
  • the receiving unit is configured to receive a first frame from a first device, wherein the first frame comprises a first field, and the first field comprises an operation mode parameter.
  • the first field includes an indication of the duration of the operation mode switch.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the communication device further includes:
  • a generating unit configured to generate a second frame, wherein the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters;
  • a sending unit configured to send the second frame to the first device.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the sending unit sends the second frame to the first device, specifically configured to:
  • the second frame is sent to the first device.
  • the sending unit is further used to: send a fifth frame to the first device, wherein the fifth frame is used to request the second device to The device transmits data to the first device.
  • the receiving unit is further used to: receive a third frame from the first device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the sending unit is further used to: after receiving the third frame from the first device, send data to the first device.
  • the sending unit is further configured to: when the operating mode switching duration indication in the first field is a second value, send data to the first device after a time indicated by the operating mode switching duration.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the fifth frame is an RTS frame.
  • the sending unit is further used to: send a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the current TXOP.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication device.
  • the communication device can be applied to the first device, or to a module (for example, a chip or a processor) in the first device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the first device.
  • the beneficial effects can be found in the description of the fifth aspect, which will not be repeated here.
  • the communication device has the function of implementing the behavior in the method example of the fifth aspect above.
  • the function can be implemented by hardware, or by hardware executing corresponding software.
  • the hardware or software includes one or more modules corresponding to the above functions.
  • the communication device includes:
  • the receiving unit is used to receive a second frame from a second device, the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the communication device further includes:
  • a generating unit configured to generate a first frame, wherein the first frame comprises a first field, and the first field comprises an operation mode parameter;
  • a sending unit configured to send the first frame to the second device.
  • the first field includes an indication of the duration of the operation mode switch.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the sending unit is further configured to send a sixth frame to the second device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the sending unit is further used to send a third frame to the second device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the sending unit sends the third frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the third frame is sent to the second device.
  • the sending unit sends the third frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the third frame is sent to the second device after the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the sending unit sends the third frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the sixth frame is a CTS frame.
  • the receiving unit is further configured to receive a fourth frame from the second device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate an end of the TXOP.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication device.
  • the communication device can be applied to the second device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the second device, or to a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • a module e.g., a chip or a processor
  • the beneficial effects can be found in the description of the sixth aspect, which will not be described here.
  • the communication device has the function of implementing the behavior in the method example of the sixth aspect.
  • the function can be implemented by hardware, or by hardware executing corresponding software.
  • the hardware or software includes one or more modules corresponding to the above functions.
  • the communication device includes:
  • a generating unit configured to generate a second frame, wherein the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters;
  • a sending unit is used to send the second frame to the first device.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the sending unit sends the second frame to the first device, specifically for:
  • the second frame is sent to the first device.
  • the communication device further includes:
  • the receiving unit is configured to receive a first frame from the first device, wherein the first frame comprises a first field, and the first field comprises an operation mode parameter.
  • the first field includes an indication of operation mode switching duration.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the receiving unit is further configured to receive a sixth frame from the first device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the receiving unit is further used to receive a third frame from the first device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the sending unit is further configured to send data to the first device after receiving the third frame from the first device.
  • the sending unit is further configured to send data to the first device after a time indicated by the operating mode switching duration time when the operating mode switching duration time indication in the first field is a second value.
  • the sending unit is further configured to send data to the first device after receiving the sixth frame from the first device.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the sixth frame is a CTS frame.
  • the sending unit is further used to send a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the TXOP.
  • a communication device which may be the first device in the above method embodiment, or a chip or processor set in the first device.
  • the communication device may include a processor, the processor is coupled to a memory, the memory is used to store programs or instructions, and when the program or instruction is executed by the processor, the communication device executes the method executed by the first device, or the chip or processor in the first device in the above method embodiment.
  • a communication device which may be the second device in the above method embodiment, or a chip or processor set in the second device.
  • the communication device may include a processor, the processor is coupled to a memory, the memory is used to store programs or instructions, and when the program or instruction is executed by the processor, the communication device executes the method executed by the second device, or the chip or processor in the second device in the above method embodiment.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a computer-readable storage medium, which stores a computer program or computer instructions.
  • the computer program or computer instructions When the computer program or computer instructions are run on a computer, the computer executes the method in the above-mentioned first aspect or any possible implementation of the first aspect, the second aspect or any possible implementation of the second aspect, the third aspect or any possible implementation of the third aspect, the fourth aspect or any possible implementation of the fourth aspect, the fifth aspect or any possible implementation of the fifth aspect, and the sixth aspect or any possible implementation of the sixth aspect.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a computer program product comprising program instructions, which, when running on a computer, enables the computer to execute the method in the above-mentioned first aspect or any possible implementation of the first aspect, the second aspect or any possible implementation of the second aspect, the third aspect or any possible implementation of the third aspect, the fourth aspect or any possible implementation of the fourth aspect, the fifth aspect or any possible implementation of the fifth aspect, and the sixth aspect or any possible implementation of the sixth aspect.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a chip system, which includes a processor for implementing the functions in the above-mentioned methods.
  • the chip system may further include a memory for storing program instructions and/or data.
  • the chip system may be composed of a chip, or may include a chip and other discrete devices.
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication system, which includes the first device provided by the first aspect or the third aspect, and may also include the second device provided by the second aspect or the fourth aspect, the first device is used to execute the method in the first aspect or any possible implementation of the first aspect, the third aspect or any possible implementation of the third aspect, and the fifth aspect or any possible implementation of the fifth aspect, and the second device is used to execute the method in the second aspect or any possible implementation of the second aspect, the fourth aspect or any possible implementation of the fourth aspect, and the sixth aspect or any possible implementation of the sixth aspect.
  • FIG1 is a schematic diagram of a network architecture provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG2 is a diagram of an implementation scenario of an OMI mechanism provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG3( a ) is a schematic diagram of the structure of an OM control field provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG3( b ) is a schematic diagram of a scenario of transmitting data within a TXOP provided in an embodiment of the present application
  • FIG4 is a flow chart of a communication method provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG5 is a flow chart of another communication method provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG6 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a second frame provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG7 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a second field provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG8 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a first frame provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG9 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a first field provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG10 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a third frame provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG11 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a third field provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG12 is a schematic diagram of a scenario in which the first device sends a third frame
  • FIG13 is a schematic diagram illustrating an exemplary communication method provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG14 is a flow chart of another communication method provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG15 is a schematic diagram illustrating another communication method provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG16 is a flow chart of another communication method provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG17 is a schematic diagram illustrating an exemplary communication method provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG18 is a schematic diagram illustrating an exemplary communication method in a multi-user scenario provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG19 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG20 is a schematic diagram of the structure of another communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG21 is a schematic diagram of the structure of another communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG22 is a schematic diagram of the structure of another communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG23 is a schematic diagram of the structure of another communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG24 is a schematic diagram of the structure of another communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 25 is a schematic diagram of the structure of another communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • references to "one embodiment” or “some embodiments” etc. described in the embodiments of the present application mean that one or more embodiments of the present application include specific features, structures or characteristics described in conjunction with the embodiment. Therefore, the statements “in one embodiment”, “in some embodiments”, “in some other embodiments”, “in some other embodiments”, etc. that appear in different places in this specification do not necessarily refer to the same embodiment, but mean “one or more but not all embodiments", unless otherwise specifically emphasized in other ways.
  • the terms “including”, “comprising”, “having” and their variations all mean “including but not limited to”, unless otherwise specifically emphasized in other ways.
  • the embodiments of the present application can be applied to sensing systems, and can also be applied to systems that comply with IEEE 802.11 system standards, such as 802.11bf, 802.11a/b/g, 802.11n, 802.11ac, 802.11ax, or their next generation, such as 802.11be, Wi-Fi 7 or EHT, or a system with a standard of the next generation, such as Wi-Fi 8, UHR, Wi-Fi AI and other 802.11 series protocols of wireless local area network systems, or wireless personal area network systems based on ultra-wideband UWB, etc., and can also be applied to wireless local area network (WLAN) scenarios.
  • IEEE 802.11 system standards such as 802.11bf, 802.11a/b/g, 802.11n, 802.11ac, 802.11ax
  • their next generation such as 802.11be, Wi-Fi 7 or EHT
  • a system with a standard of the next generation such as Wi-Fi 8, UHR, Wi-Fi AI and other 802.11 series
  • the embodiments of the present application can also be applied to wireless local area network systems such as the Internet of Things (IoT) network or the Vehicle to X (V2X) network.
  • IoT Internet of Things
  • V2X Vehicle to X
  • the embodiments of the present application can also be applied to other possible communication systems, such as long term evolution (LTE) system, LTE frequency division duplex (FDD) system, LTE time division duplex (TDD), universal mobile telecommunication system (UMTS), worldwide interoperability for microwave access (WiMAX) communication system, and future 6G communication system.
  • LTE long term evolution
  • FDD frequency division duplex
  • TDD LTE time division duplex
  • UMTS universal mobile telecommunication system
  • WiMAX worldwide interoperability for microwave access
  • future 6G communication system future 6G communication system.
  • WLAN started from the 802.11a/g standard, and went through 802.11n, 802.11ac, 802.11ax, and the 802.11be and Wi-Fi 8 that are being discussed now.
  • 802.11n can also be called high throughput (HT); 802.11ac can also be called very high throughput (VHT); 802.11ax can also be called high efficiency (HE) or Wi-Fi 6; 802.11be can also be called extremely high throughput (EHT) or Wi-Fi 7, and the standards before HT, such as 802.11a/b/g, are collectively called non-high throughput (non-HT).
  • Figure 1 is a schematic diagram of a network architecture provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • a network architecture including 1 wireless access point AP and 2 stations is used as an example for explanation.
  • the STA associated with the AP can receive wireless frames sent by the AP and can also send wireless frames to the AP.
  • the embodiment of the present application is also applicable to communication between APs.
  • each AP can communicate with each other through a distributed system (DS), and the embodiment of the present application is also applicable to communication between STAs.
  • DS distributed system
  • the number of APs and STAs in Figure 1 is only an example, and can be more or less.
  • the STA involved in the embodiments of the present application is a device with wireless communication function, supports communication using the WLAN protocol, and has the ability to communicate with other stations or access points in the WLAN network.
  • a station can be called a non-access point station (non-AP STA).
  • non-AP STA non-access point station
  • a STA is any user communication device that allows a user to communicate with an AP and then communicate with a WLAN.
  • the device can be a complete device, or a chip or processing system installed in the complete device. Devices installed with these chips or processing systems can implement the methods and functions of the embodiments of the present application under the control of the chip or processing system.
  • STA may be various user terminals, user devices, access devices, subscriber stations, subscriber units, mobile stations, user agents, user equipment or other names with wireless communication functions
  • user terminals may include various handheld devices, vehicle-mounted devices, wearable devices, computing devices or other processing devices connected to wireless modems with wireless communication functions, as well as various forms of user equipment (UE), mobile stations (MS), terminals, terminal equipment, portable communication devices, handheld machines, portable computing devices, entertainment devices, gaming devices or systems, global positioning system devices or any other suitable devices configured to communicate over a wireless medium.
  • STA may be a router, a switch, a bridge, etc.
  • stations or STAs are collectively referred to as stations or STAs.
  • the access point (e.g., AP) involved in the embodiments of the present application is a device with wireless communication function, supports communication using WLAN protocol, has the function of communicating with other devices in the WLAN network (e.g., stations or other access points), and of course, can also have the function of communicating with other devices.
  • an access point can be called an access point station (AP STA).
  • the device can be a complete device, or a chip or processing system installed in the complete device, etc. The devices installed with these chips or processing systems can implement the methods and functions of the embodiments of the present application under the control of the chip or processing system.
  • the AP in the embodiments of the present application can be a device that provides services for STA and can support the 802.11 series of protocols.
  • AP can be a communication entity such as a communication server, router, switch, bridge, etc.; AP can include various forms of macro base stations, micro base stations, relay stations, etc., and of course AP can also be chips and processing systems in these various forms of devices. system, thereby realizing the methods and functions of the embodiments of the present application.
  • the AP and STA involved in the embodiments of the present application may be AP and STA applicable to the IEEE 802.11 system standard.
  • AP is a device deployed in a wireless communication network to provide wireless communication functions for its associated STA.
  • the AP can be used as the hub of the communication system, and is usually a network-side product that supports the MAC and PHY of the 802.11 system standard.
  • it may be a base station, a router, a gateway, a repeater, a communication server, a switch or a bridge and other communication equipment, wherein the base station may include various forms of macro base stations, micro base stations, relay stations, etc.
  • the above-mentioned devices are collectively referred to as AP.
  • STA is usually a terminal product that supports the medium access control (MAC) and physical layer (PHY) of the 802.11 system standard, such as a mobile phone, a laptop computer, etc.
  • MAC medium access control
  • PHY physical layer
  • WLAN system can provide high-speed and low-latency transmission.
  • WLAN system will be applied to more scenarios or industries, for example, in the Internet of Things industry, in the Internet of Vehicles industry or in the banking industry, in corporate offices, stadiums and exhibition halls, concert halls, hotel rooms, dormitories, wards, classrooms, supermarkets, squares, streets, production workshops and warehouses, etc.
  • the equipment (such as access points or stations) supporting WLAN communication can be sensor nodes in smart cities (such as smart water meters, smart meters, smart air detection nodes), smart devices in smart homes (such as smart cameras, projectors, display screens, TVs, audio, refrigerators, washing machines, etc.), nodes in the Internet of Things, entertainment terminals (such as wearable devices such as AR and VR), smart devices in smart offices (such as printers, projectors, loudspeakers, audio, etc.), Internet of Vehicles devices in the Internet of Vehicles, infrastructure in daily life scenarios (such as vending machines, self-service navigation desks in supermarkets, self-service cash registers, self-service ordering machines, etc.), and equipment in large sports and music venues, etc.
  • there is no special restriction on the specific forms of STA and AP which are only exemplary descriptions.
  • the 802.11ax standard introduces the OMI mechanism.
  • STA is the OMI initiator and AP is the OMI responder.
  • STA can send a data frame or control frame containing an operating mode (OM) control field to AP to enable STA to dynamically switch single-user/multi-user operating mode, channel bandwidth, maximum number of received spatial streams, etc.
  • OM operating mode
  • Figure 2 is an implementation scenario diagram of an OMI mechanism provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • the STA can switch the single-user/multi-user operating mode of the uplink by sending a transmit operating mode (TOM) to the AP, and can also switch the channel bandwidth and maximum number of spatial streams of the downlink by sending a receive operating mode (ROM) to the AP.
  • TOM transmit operating mode
  • ROM receive operating mode
  • Figure 3(a) is a structural schematic diagram of an OM control field provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • the OM control field may include the receiver number of spatial streams (Rx NSS), channel bandwidth (channelwidth), uplink multi-user disabled (UL MU disabled), transmitter the number of space-time streams (Tx NSTS), ER single user disabled (ER SU disabled), recommendation to re-sound channel or increase channel sounding (DL MU-MIMO resound recommendation) and uplink multi-user data disabled (uplink multi-user data disabled, UL MU data disabled).
  • Rx NSS receiver number of spatial streams
  • channel bandwidth channelwidth
  • uplink multi-user disabled UL MU disabled
  • Tx NSTS transmitter the number of space-time streams
  • ER SU disabled ER single user disabled
  • recommendation to re-sound channel or increase channel sounding DL MU-MIMO resound recommendation
  • uplink multi-user data disabled uplink multi-user data disabled, UL MU data disabled.
  • the current OMI mechanism has the following problems:
  • Supporting STA to initiate OM negotiation results in poor flexibility in operating mode switching and low efficiency in service transmission
  • FIG3(b) is a schematic diagram of a scenario of transmitting data within a TXOP provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the STA when the AP initiates downlink data transmission, the STA cannot sense the amount of data to be transmitted on the AP side, initiate OM negotiation and complete the operation mode switching within a TXOP, resulting in poor timeliness of the STA operation mode switching;
  • STA cannot notify AP of the current operation mode switching status or switching completion time, which may cause AP to send data in advance, resulting in frequent retransmission and packet loss of data packets, resulting in reduced throughput and increased transmission delay;
  • an embodiment of the present application provides a communication method, in which a first device can generate and send a first frame to a second device to indicate whether an operating mode parameter is included, so that the first device actively initiates operating mode negotiation, or responds to the operating mode negotiation initiated by the second device through the first frame, thereby improving the flexibility of operating mode switching and improving the efficiency of service transmission.
  • the present application provides a variety of transmission methods for operating mode switching, which will be described below through the following embodiments. Some of these transmission methods for operating mode switching are only for some processes in the OMI mechanism, and some can be applied to any one or more processes in the OMI mechanism. It should be understood that these transmission methods for operating mode switching can be used in combination with each other. For example, one method may be used for a process in the OMI mechanism and another method may be used for another process, or one method and another method may be used for a process in the OMI mechanism.
  • the OMI mechanism may change with the evolution of the technical solution, and the technical solution provided by this application is not limited to the process described below. Used to describe scenarios, it is also applicable to scenarios with similar problems.
  • the first device and the second device are used as the execution subjects of the interactive illustration as an example to illustrate the method, but the present application does not limit the execution subjects of the interactive illustration.
  • the first device may also be a chip, a chip system, or a processor that supports the first device to implement the method, or a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the first device;
  • the second device may also be a chip, a chip system, or a processor that supports the second device to implement the method, or a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • the first device may be STA and the second device may be AP for exemplary explanation. The embodiments of the present application are uniformly explained here and will not be repeated later.
  • Figure 4 is a flow chart of a communication method provided in an embodiment of the present application. As shown in Figure 4, the communication method includes but is not limited to the following steps.
  • S401 A first device and a second device establish a wireless communication link, and the first device operates in a first operating mode.
  • the first device and the second device establish a wireless communication link.
  • the first device can operate in a first operating mode, and the second device can operate in a third operating mode.
  • Different operation modes may correspond to different bandwidths, wherein the first operation mode may correspond to a first bandwidth, which may be a first channel bandwidth; the second operation mode may correspond to a second bandwidth, which may be a second channel bandwidth; the third operation mode may correspond to a third bandwidth, which may be a third channel bandwidth.
  • the first bandwidth is less than or equal to the third bandwidth.
  • the second bandwidth is less than or equal to the third bandwidth.
  • different operating modes may correspond to different power consumption operating modes.
  • the first operating mode is a low power consumption monitoring mode
  • the second operating mode is a high power consumption receiving mode.
  • S402 The first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode, and communicates with the second device.
  • the first device may switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode when a first condition is met, where the first condition includes one or more of the following:
  • the first device changes from a listening state to a data transmission state
  • the amount of data to be transmitted between the first device and the second device ranges from less than or equal to a first threshold to greater than the first threshold.
  • the first threshold may be predefined.
  • the implementation manner in which the first device switches from the first operation mode to the second operation mode may be any implementation manner shown in the following FIG. 5 , FIG. 14 , and FIG. 16 .
  • Figure 5 is a flow chart of another communication method provided in an embodiment of the present application. As shown in Figure 5, the communication method includes but is not limited to the following steps, wherein steps S501, S502 and S508 are optional steps.
  • a first device sends a seventh frame to a second device, which is used to indicate a switching time when the first device switches from a first operating mode to a second operating mode.
  • the second device receives the seventh frame from the first device.
  • the first device and the second device may define a switching time for the first device to switch from the first operation mode to the second operation mode, which may be implemented in any of the following ways:
  • Method 1 Static negotiation. Specifically, the first device and the second device may agree on a switching time for the first device to switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode through a protocol or a predefined method. Optionally, the first device and the second device may not send the first frame and the second frame.
  • Mode 2 Semi-static negotiation Specifically, when the first device is accessing the second device, the access interaction association frame may carry the switching time of the first device switching from the first operation mode to the second operation mode.
  • Mode 3 Dynamic negotiation Specifically, the first device may send the seventh frame to the second device to inform the second device of the switching time when the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode.
  • S502 The second device sends an eighth frame to the first device in response to the seventh frame.
  • the first device receives the eighth frame from the second device.
  • the second device may further send an eighth frame to the first device in response to the seventh frame, indicating that the switching time for the first device to switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode is known.
  • the second device generates a second frame including a second field, where the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second field is used to recommend operating mode parameters, which can be understood as the second device recommending operating mode parameters to the first device, or can be understood as the second device indicating operating mode parameters to the first device. That is, the first device can determine the operating mode parameters with reference to the second field or directly use the operating mode parameters indicated by the second field.
  • the second frame may be understood as an RTS frame including the second field, or a trigger frame including the second field, or a management frame including the second field, or an action frame including the second field.
  • the second frame may be an OMI RTS frame. It may be understood that the OMI RTS frame is only an exemplary name and may be other names. This embodiment does not limit the name of the second frame.
  • the second frame can be an RTS frame including a second field, wherein B7-B2 of the frame control field of the second frame is 101111, and the second frame can include a frame control field, a duration field, a receiver address (RA) field, a transmitter address (TA) field, a second field, and a frame check sequence (FCS) field.
  • RA receiver address
  • TA transmitter address
  • FCS frame check sequence
  • FIG. 7 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a second field provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • the second field may be an OM control field, and the OM control field may include Rx NSS and channel bandwidth.
  • the OM control field may include Rx NSS and channel bandwidth.
  • the second field may be an extended OM control field.
  • the extended OM control field may include, in addition to Rx NSS and channel width, a ROM recommendation indication and/or a negotiate indication, and may further include a reserved subfield.
  • Rx NSS and channel width may include, in addition to Rx NSS and channel width, a ROM recommendation indication and/or a negotiate indication, and may further include a reserved subfield.
  • the extended OM control field may also include a signal bandwidth (signalwidth).
  • signal bandwidth For specific values of the signal bandwidth and corresponding descriptions, please refer to Table 3 below.
  • the second device can pre-store PHY layer module calibration data in different operating modes, and can select corresponding PHY layer module calibration data according to the operating mode parameters (e.g., channel bandwidth (channelwidth)) contained in the second field in the second frame, and configure the PHY layer register.
  • the operating mode parameters e.g., channel bandwidth (channelwidth)
  • the operating mode switching time can be reduced and the latency can be reduced.
  • the second device can switch from operating at a channel bandwidth of 20MHz to operating at 160MHz, and the operating mode switching time can be reduced from 100ms to 200ms to about 100us, achieving microsecond channel switching.
  • the second device pre-stores PHY layer module calibration data in different operating modes.
  • the second device can pre-store PHY layer module calibration data in a first bandwidth operating mode, where the first bandwidth is a bandwidth greater than or equal to a first threshold, so that the second device can After the switching, a signal bandwidth smaller than the first bandwidth is used to send and receive signals.
  • the second device may select corresponding PHY layer module calibration data and configure a PHY layer register according to the channel bandwidth (signalwidth) included in the second field in the second frame. For example, the second device operates on a 20MHz channel bandwidth unchanged, and may switch a signal bandwidth on the 20MHz channel bandwidth, such as switching from a 20MHz signal bandwidth on a 20MHz channel bandwidth to a 160MHz signal bandwidth on a 20MHz channel bandwidth.
  • S504 The second device sends a second frame to the first device.
  • the first device receives the second frame from the second device.
  • the second device may send a second frame to the first device.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation with the first device based on the amount of data to be transmitted, latency requirements, channel status and other information of its own business, thereby improving the flexibility of the operation mode switching negotiation.
  • the first device does not need to perceive the amount of data transmitted on the second device side.
  • the first device only needs to respond to the second frame from the second device to achieve the operation mode switching, thereby improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device and reducing the latency of the operation mode switching.
  • the second device may actively initiate OM negotiation by sending a second frame to the first device, and set the operation mode negotiation indication field included in the second field of the second frame to 1, indicating that the operation mode parameters are recommended to the first device.
  • the second device can also select a reasonable and efficient ROM configuration scheme for the first device according to the amount of data to be transmitted, delay requirements, channel status and other information of the service.
  • the operation mode recommendation indication (ROM recommendation indication) field included in the second field in the second frame is set to 1, indicating that the ROM recommendation information is carried by using the Rx NSS and channel bandwidth fields. Allowing the second device to recommend a ROM configuration scheme for the first device according to the amount of data to be transmitted, delay requirements, channel status and other information of the service can improve the effectiveness of the operation mode switching of the first device.
  • the first device generates a first frame including a first field, where the first field includes an operation mode parameter.
  • the first frame can be understood as a CTS frame including the first field, or a trigger frame including the first field, or a management frame including the first field, or an action frame including the first field.
  • the first frame can be an OMI CTS frame. It can be understood that the OMI CTS frame is only an exemplary name and can also be other names. This embodiment does not limit the name of the first frame.
  • the first frame may be a CTS frame including a first field, wherein B7-B2 of a frame control field of the first frame is 110011, and the first frame may include a frame control field, a duration field, a receiver address (RA) field, a first field, and a frame check sequence (FCS) field.
  • B7-B2 of a frame control field of the first frame is 110011
  • the first frame may include a frame control field, a duration field, a receiver address (RA) field, a first field, and a frame check sequence (FCS) field.
  • RA receiver address
  • FCS frame check sequence
  • the first field may be the OM control field shown in Figure 3 (a) above.
  • the second field may be an extended OM control field.
  • the extended OM control field includes Rx NSS, channel bandwidth, UL MU disabled, Tx NSTS, ER SU disabled, recommendation to re-sound channel or increase channel sounding (DL MU-MIMO resound recommendation) and UL MU data disabled, and may also include operating mode switching duration (duration indication) and reserved (reserved) subfields.
  • operating mode switching duration duration
  • reserved reserved
  • the extended OM control field may also include a switch duration (switchduration).
  • switchduration For specific field names and corresponding descriptions, please refer to Table 5 below.
  • the extended OM control field may also include a signal width.
  • the first device may pre-store PHY layer module calibration data in different operating modes.
  • the first device may send a first frame for responding to the second frame to the second device, and perform the operation according to the first field in the first frame.
  • the mode parameters (such as channel bandwidth (channelwidth)) select the corresponding PHY layer module calibration data and configure the PHY layer register.
  • the operating mode switching time can be reduced and the latency can be reduced.
  • the first device can switch from operating at a channel bandwidth of 20MHz to operating at 160MHz, and the operating mode switching time can be reduced from 100ms to 200ms to about 100us, achieving microsecond channel switching.
  • the first device pre-stores PHY layer module calibration data under different operating modes.
  • the first device can pre-store PHY layer module calibration data of a first bandwidth operating mode, and the first bandwidth is a bandwidth greater than or equal to a first threshold, so that the first device can use a signal bandwidth less than the first bandwidth to send and receive signals after channel switching, thereby simplifying the complexity of implementation.
  • the first device may select corresponding PHY layer module calibration data and configure a PHY layer register according to the channel bandwidth (signalwidth) included in the first field in the first frame. For example, the first device operates on a 20MHz channel bandwidth unchanged, and the signal bandwidth on the 20MHz channel bandwidth may be switched, such as switching from a 20MHz signal bandwidth on a 20MHz channel bandwidth to a 160MHz signal bandwidth on a 20MHz channel bandwidth.
  • the first device sends a first frame to the second device.
  • the second device receives the first frame from the first device.
  • the first device may send the first frame to the second device in response to the second frame.
  • the second device may send data (such as a presentation protocol data unit (PPDU)) to the first device, and the first device may send an ACK frame to the second device to indicate receipt of the data or to indicate whether to resend the data.
  • the first device may send data to the second device, and the second device may send an ACK frame to the first device.
  • PPDU presentation protocol data unit
  • the first device and the second device transmit and receive data, which can improve air interface utilization and avoid the problem of other users occupying the channel due to a long switching time.
  • the first device sends a third frame indicating that the operation mode switching is completed to the second device.
  • the second device receives the third frame from the first device.
  • the third frame can be understood as an ACK frame used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed. That is, after the first device completes the switch from the first operation mode to the second operation mode, the first device can send the third frame to the second device.
  • the third frame can be an OMI ACK frame. It can be understood that the OMI ACK frame is only an exemplary name and can also be other names. This embodiment does not limit the name of the third frame.
  • FIG 10 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a third frame provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • B7-B2 of the frame structure (framecontrol) field of the third frame is 110111, and the third frame may include a frame control (frame control) field, a duration (duration) field, a receiver address (RA) field, a third field and a frame check sequence (FCS) field.
  • frame control frame control
  • duration duration
  • RA receiver address
  • FCS frame check sequence
  • Figure 11 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a third field provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • the third field may be an OM announcement field
  • the OM announcement field may include Rx NSS, channel bandwidth, UL MU disabled, Tx NSTS, ER SU disabled, recommendation to re-detect the channel or increase channel detection (DL MU-MIMO resound recommendation), UL MU data disabled, completion indication, and reserved subfields.
  • the first device may send the third frame to the second device in any of the following ways:
  • Mode 1 When the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field is a first value, the first device sends a third frame to the second device after completing the operation mode switching.
  • the first value may be 0.
  • the operation mode switching duration indication subfield included in the first field in the first frame is set to 0, it means that the first field does not carry the operation mode switching duration of the first device, and the first device may send a third frame to the second device after completing the operation mode switching to notify the second device to send data.
  • Method 2 When the operation mode switching duration of the first device is longer than the time indicated by the operation mode switching duration in the first field, the first device sends a third frame to the second device after completing the operation mode switching.
  • the operation mode switching time of the first device is long and cannot be completed within the time indicated by the operation mode switching duration in the first field.
  • the first device can send a third frame to the second device after completing the operation mode switching to indicate that the operation mode switching has been completed, so as to notify the second device.
  • the second device sends data.
  • the first device can select the original signal bandwidth or the switched signal bandwidth to send the third frame to the second device.
  • Figure 12 is a schematic diagram of the scenario in which the first device sends the third frame.
  • the first device indicates through the third frame that the operating mode switch has been completed, so that efficient and reliable service transmission can be achieved. It can solve the problem that the first device cannot notify the second device of the switching status or switching completion time of the current operating mode, which may cause the AP to send data in advance and cause frequent retransmission and packet loss of data packets, resulting in reduced throughput and increased transmission delay.
  • the first device may no longer send the third frame to the second device.
  • S509 Data is transmitted between the first device and the second device.
  • the second device may send data to the first device.
  • the second device may send data to the first device in any of the following ways:
  • Mode 1 After receiving the third frame from the first device, the second device sends data to the first device. Specifically: In a possible implementation mode, after receiving the third frame, the second device can send data to the first device immediately according to the switched operation mode; In a possible implementation mode, after receiving the third frame, the second device sends data to the first device after a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS) according to the switched operation mode; In a possible implementation mode, after the second device receives the third frame, the first device sends a request message for requesting to send data to the second device, and after receiving the request message, the second device sends data to the first device according to the switched operation mode; In a possible implementation mode, after the second device receives the third frame, the first device sends a request frame (requestframe) for requesting to send data to the second device, and after receiving the request frame, the second device replies to the first device with a response frame (responseframe) in response to the request frame, and then sends data to the first device according to the switched operation mode;
  • Mode 2 When the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field is a second value, the second device sends data to the first device after the time indicated by the operation mode switching duration. For example, when the operation mode switching duration indication subfield included in the first field in the first frame is set to 1, the switching duration subfield included in the first field indicates the operation mode switching time of the first device, and the second device can send data to the first device after the time.
  • Mode three sending data to the second device after the switching time when the first device switches from the first operation mode to the second operation mode negotiated before the TXOP.
  • the second device can determine the time to send data to the first device based on the operating mode switching duration indication received in the third frame or the first field or based on the negotiated switching time for the first device to switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • S510 The second device sends a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the current TXOP.
  • the first device receives the fourth frame from the second device.
  • the fourth frame may be a CF-end frame.
  • the second device After the second device sends data to the first device, it can send a fourth frame to end the current TXOP in advance, thereby achieving efficient service transmission.
  • FIG. 13 is a schematic diagram of an exemplary communication method provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the first frame is an OMI CTS frame
  • the second frame is an OMI RTS frame
  • the third frame is an OMI ACK frame
  • the fourth frame is a CF-end frame
  • the second device sends data to the first device as an example for exemplary description:
  • the operating mode types can include OM1, OM2, OM3 and OM4.
  • the channel bandwidth and signal The bandwidths are BW1 and SW1 respectively.
  • the channel bandwidth and signal bandwidth corresponding to OM2 are BW2 and SW2 respectively.
  • the channel bandwidth and signal bandwidth corresponding to OM3 are BW1 and SW2 respectively.
  • the channel bandwidth and signal bandwidth corresponding to OM4 are BW1 and SW1 or SW2 respectively.
  • the second device actively initiates OM negotiation. Specifically, within the current TXOP, the second device may send an OMI RTS frame to the first device based on the target operation mode OM1 to initiate OM negotiation.
  • the OMI RTS may indicate to the first device that the target operation mode type is OM1, i.e., request the first device to switch from the first operation mode OM2 to the second operation mode OM1.
  • the OMI RTS frame includes a second field, which is an OM control field or an extended OM control field.
  • the first device may respond to the OMI RTS frame and send an OMI CTS frame to the second device based on OM2 to respond to the OMI RTS frame.
  • the OMI CTS frame includes a first field, which is an OM control field or an extended OM control field.
  • the extended OM control field includes an operation mode switching duration indication subfield.
  • the first device can send an OMI ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 (i.e., based on the operating mode type before switching or the operating mode type after switching) to indicate that the operating mode has been switched, so as to notify the second device to send data.
  • OM4 i.e., based on the operating mode type before switching or the operating mode type after switching
  • the first device can send an OMI ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the operation mode has been switched, so as to notify the second device to send data.
  • the second device can send data to the first device based on OM3, and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM2 to indicate that the data is received or whether to resend the data.
  • the first device and the second device send and receive data, which can improve the utilization rate of the air interface and avoid the problem of other users occupying the channel due to the long switching time.
  • the second device can send data to the first device based on OM1 after a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS), and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the data is received.
  • the second device can also send a CF-end frame to the first device based on OM1 to end the current TXOP in advance.
  • TXOP2 of the first device after the operation mode switching is shorter than TXOP1 before the operation mode switching, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • the first device when the operation mode switching duration indication (durationindication) subfield in the OMI CTS frame is set to 1, the first device can complete the operation mode switching at the time indicated by the switch duration (switch duration) included in the first field (i.e., the switch duration (switch duration)), and there is no need to send an OMI ACK frame to the second device.
  • the second device can confirm that the first device has completed the operation mode switching according to the time indicated by the switch duration (switch duration), and can send data to the first device based on OM1, and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the data has been received.
  • the second device can send data to the first device based on OM3, and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM2 to indicate that the data has been received or to indicate whether to resend the data.
  • the first device and the second device send and receive data, which can improve the air interface utilization rate and avoid the problem of other users occupying the channel due to the long switching time.
  • the second device can also send a CF-end frame to the first device based on OM1 to end the current TXOP in advance.
  • TXOP3 of the first device after the operation mode is switched is shorter than TXOP1 before the operation mode is switched, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • FIG. 13 (c), FIG. 13 (d), FIG. 13 (e), and FIG. 13 (f) and FIG. 13 (a) and FIG. 13 (b) The difference between FIG. 13 (c), FIG. 13 (d), FIG. 13 (e), and FIG. 13 (f) and FIG. 13 (a) and FIG. 13 (b) is that in FIG. 13 (a) and FIG. 13 (b), the switching time of the first device from the first operation mode to the second operation mode can be negotiated within the current TXOP, and in FIG. 13 (c), FIG. 13 (d), FIG. 13 (e), and FIG. 13 (f), the switching time of the first device from the first operation mode to the second operation mode can be negotiated outside the current TXOP.
  • FIG. 13 (c), FIG. 13 (d), FIG. 13 (e), and FIG. 13 (f) the switching time of the first device from the first operation mode to the second operation mode can be negotiated outside the current TXOP.
  • the first device and the second device may statically negotiate the switching time for the first device to switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode before the current TXOP starts.
  • the switching time for the first device to switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode may be agreed upon in a protocol-specified or predefined manner, such as the switching time T.
  • the second device may optionally send an RTS frame to the first device based on OM1, and the first device may send a CTS frame to the second device based on OM2.
  • the first device may start switching from the first operating mode to the second operating mode based on the switching time T.
  • the first device may optionally send an OMI ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the operating mode has been switched, so as to notify the second device to send data; after receiving the OMI ACK frame or after the switching time T, the second device starts to send data to the first device based on OM1 at a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS).
  • SIFS inter-frame interval
  • the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the data has been received.
  • the second device can send data to the first device based on OM3, and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM2 to indicate that the data has been received or to indicate whether to resend the data.
  • the first device and the second device send and receive data, which can improve the air interface utilization rate and avoid the problem of other users occupying the channel due to the long switching time.
  • the second device can also send a CF-end frame to the first device based on OM1 to end the current TXOP in advance.
  • the first device switches the operating mode.
  • the TXOP2 after the operation mode switching is shorter than the TXOP1 before the operation mode switching, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • the first device and the second device may semi-statically negotiate the switching time of the first device from the first operation mode to the second operation mode before the current TXOP starts.
  • the switching time of the first device from the first operation mode to the second operation mode may be carried in the accessed interactive association frame (such as the seventh frame and the eighth frame described below), such as the switching time T.
  • the implementation manner in the current TXOP is the same as that of FIG13 (c) above, and the specific description may refer to FIG13 (c), which will not be repeated here.
  • the first device and the second device can dynamically negotiate the switching time of the first device from the first operation mode to the second operation mode before the current TXOP starts.
  • the second device sends a second frame to the first device based on OM2 or OM3 to initiate OM negotiation.
  • the second device can indicate to the first device that the target operation mode type is OM1, that is, requesting the first device to switch from the first operation mode OM2 to the second operation mode OM1.
  • the second frame includes a second field, the second field is an OM control field or an extended OM control field.
  • the first device can respond to the second frame and send a first frame to the second device based on OM2.
  • the first frame includes a first field, the first field is an extended OM control field, and the extended OM control field includes an operation mode switching duration indication (durationindication) subfield.
  • the operation mode switching duration indication (durationindication) subfield is used to indicate the switching time T.
  • the implementation method in the current TXOP is the same as that of (c) of FIG. 13 above. The specific description can refer to (c) of FIG. 13 and will not be repeated.
  • FIG. 13 (e), FIG. 13 (f) and FIG. 13 (c), FIG. 13 (d) The difference between FIG. 13 (e), FIG. 13 (f) and FIG. 13 (c), FIG. 13 (d) is that in FIG. 13 (c), FIG. 13 (d), the first device can implement switching from the first operation mode to the second operation mode within the current TXOP. In FIG. 13 (e), FIG. 13 (f), the first device can implement switching from the first operation mode to the second operation mode outside the current TXOP.
  • the details are as follows:
  • the first device and the second device may semi-statically negotiate the switching time for the first device to switch from the first operating mode to the second operating mode before the current TXOP starts.
  • the first device may send a seventh frame to the second device based on OM2, and the seventh frame is used to indicate the switching time T.
  • the second device may send an eighth frame to the first device based on OM2 or OM3 to respond to the seventh frame.
  • the second device may send a second frame to the first device based on OM2 or OM3 to initiate OM negotiation.
  • the second frame may indicate to the first device that the target operating mode type is OM1, i.e., requesting the first device to switch from the first operating mode OM2 to the second operating mode OM1.
  • the second frame includes a second field, which is an OM control field or an extended OM control field.
  • the first device may respond to the second frame by sending a first frame to the second device based on OM2, and the first frame includes a first field, which is an OM control field. After the first device sends the first frame to the second device, the switching from the first operating mode to the second operating mode is completed within the switching time T.
  • the first device can optionally send an OMI ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the operation mode has been switched, so as to notify the second device to send data.
  • the first device completes the operation mode switch before the TXOP.
  • the second device can send an RTS frame based on OM1, and the first device can send a CTS frame based on OM4 for data interaction.
  • the second device begins to periodically send data to the first device based on OM1, and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the data has been received until the current TXOP ends.
  • SIFS inter-frame interval
  • the first device completes the operation mode switch before the current TXOP, and uses the switched operation mode for data transmission in the current TXOP, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • the first device and the second device can statically negotiate the switching time of the first device from the first operating mode to the second operating mode before the current TXOP starts.
  • the first device completes the operating mode switching before the current TXOP, and uses the switched operating mode for data transmission in the current TXOP.
  • the specific description is the same as the first possible implementation, and the first possible implementation can be referred to and will not be repeated.
  • FIG. 13( f ) is a schematic diagram of downlink data transmission
  • FIG. 13( f ) is a schematic diagram of uplink data transmission.
  • the first device and the second device may semi-statically negotiate the switching time of the first device from the first operating mode to the second operating mode before the current TXOP starts.
  • the first device completes the operating mode switching before the current TXOP, and the specific description is the same as the first possible implementation, which can be referred to the first possible implementation and will not be repeated.
  • the first device may optionally send an RTS frame based on OM4, and after a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS), the second device may send a CTS frame based on OM1 to interact with data.
  • SIFS inter-frame interval
  • the first device After a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS), the first device begins to periodically send data to the first device based on OM1, and the second device sends an ACK frame to the first device based on OM1 to indicate that the data has been received until the current TXOP ends.
  • SIFS inter-frame interval
  • the first device completes the operating mode switching before the current TXOP, and uses the switched operating mode for data transmission in the current TXOP, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • the size of the serial number of the above-mentioned processes does not mean the order of execution.
  • the execution order of each process should be determined by its function and internal logic, and should not constitute any limitation on the implementation process of the embodiment of this application.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation to the first device.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation to the first device based on information such as the amount of data to be transmitted, latency requirements, and channel status of its own business, thereby improving the flexibility of operation mode switching negotiation.
  • the first device does not need to perceive the amount of data transmitted on the second device side. The first device only needs to respond to the second frame from the second device to achieve the operation mode switching, thereby improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device and reducing the delay of the operation mode switching.
  • FIG 14 is a flow chart of another communication method provided by an embodiment of the present application. As shown in Figure 14, the communication method includes but is not limited to the following steps, wherein steps S1401, S1402 and S1407 are optional steps.
  • a first device sends a seventh frame to a second device, which indicates a switching time when the first device switches from a first operating mode to a second operating mode.
  • the second device receives the seventh frame from the first device.
  • S1402 The second device sends an eighth frame to the first device in response to the seventh frame.
  • the first device receives the eighth frame from the second device.
  • steps S1401-S1402 can refer to the above steps S501-S502, which will not be repeated here.
  • the second device sends a fifth frame to the first device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the first device receives the fifth frame from the second device.
  • the fifth frame may be understood as an RTS frame that does not include the second field, ie, a regular RTS frame, which is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the first device generates a first frame including a first field, where the first field includes an operating mode parameter.
  • the first device After the first device receives the fifth frame from the second device, it can generate the first frame.
  • the specific implementation method can refer to the above step S505, which will not be described in detail here.
  • S1405 The first device sends a first frame to the second device.
  • the second device receives the first frame from the first device.
  • the first device may send a first frame to the second device to actively initiate OM negotiation.
  • the first device may send the first frame to the second device in any of the following ways:
  • Method 1 The first device can evaluate the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side according to the fifth frame, and thus independently decide whether to initiate OM negotiation, that is, independently decide whether to send the first frame to the second device. For example, when the TXOP is greater than or equal to the fourth threshold, the first device can send the first frame to the second device within the current TXOP.
  • Method 2 When the time indicated by the TXOP duration in the fifth frame exceeds a preset threshold (threshold, TH), the first device may send a first frame to the second device within the current TXOP to actively initiate OM negotiation.
  • a preset threshold threshold, TH
  • the first device can actively initiate OM negotiation to the second device within one TXOP to implement operation mode switching, thereby improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device and reducing the delay of the operation mode switching.
  • S1406 During a period (switch duration) when the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode, data is transmitted between the first device and the second device.
  • the first device sends a third frame indicating that the operation mode switching is completed to the second device.
  • the second device receives the third frame from the first device.
  • steps S1406-S1407 can refer to the above steps S507-S508, which will not be described in detail here.
  • the second device sends a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the current TXOP.
  • the first device receives the fourth frame from the second device.
  • steps S1408-S1409 can refer to the above steps S509-S510, which will not be repeated here.
  • FIG15 is a schematic diagram of another exemplary communication method provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the first frame is an OMI CTS frame
  • the third frame is an OMI ACK frame
  • the fourth frame is a CF-end frame
  • the fifth frame is an RTS frame
  • the second device sends data to the first device as an example for exemplary description:
  • the second device may send an RTS frame to the first device based on the target operation mode OM1 to request the first device to transmit data to the second device, and the first device may send an OMI CTS frame to the second device based on OM2 according to the fifth frame to initiate OM negotiation.
  • the OMI CTS frame includes a first field, which is an OM control field or an extended OM control field, and the extended OM control field includes an operation mode switching duration indication subfield.
  • the first device can be based on the operation mode switching after the operation mode switching is completed.
  • OM4 sends an OMI ACK frame to the second device to indicate that the operation mode has been switched, so as to notify the second device to send data.
  • the first device can send an OMI ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the operation mode has been switched, so as to notify the second device to send data.
  • the second device can send data to the first device based on OM3, and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM2 to indicate that the data has been received or to indicate whether to resend the data.
  • the first device and the second device send and receive data, which can improve the utilization rate of the air interface and avoid the problem of other users occupying the channel due to the long switching time.
  • the second device can send data to the first device based on OM1 after a certain time gap (SIFS).
  • the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the data has been received.
  • the second device can also send a CF-end frame to the first device based on OM1 to end the current TXOP in advance.
  • TXOP2 of the first device after the operation mode switching is shorter than TXOP1 before the operation mode switching, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • the first device when the operation mode switching duration indication (durationindication) subfield in the OMI CTS frame is set to 1, the first device can complete the operation mode switching at the time indicated by the switch duration (switch duration) included in the first field (i.e., the switch duration (switch duration)), and there is no need to send an OMI ACK frame to the second device.
  • the second device can confirm that the first device has completed the operation mode switching according to the time indicated by the switch duration (switch duration), and can send data to the first device based on OM1, and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the data has been received.
  • the second device can send data to the first device based on OM3, and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM2 to indicate that the data has been received or to indicate whether to resend the data.
  • the first device and the second device send and receive data, which can improve the air interface utilization rate and avoid the problem of other users occupying the channel due to the long switching time.
  • the second device can also send a CF-end frame to the first device based on OM1 to end the current TXOP in advance.
  • TXOP3 of the first device after the operation mode is switched is shorter than TXOP1 before the operation mode is switched, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • the first device and the second device can negotiate the switching time of the first device switching from the first operation mode to the second operation mode outside the current TXOP.
  • the specific implementation method can refer to the description of Figure 13 above, which will not be repeated here.
  • the second device actively initiates the OM negotiation
  • the first device actively initiates the OM negotiation.
  • the first device and the second device may semi-statically negotiate the switching time of the first device from the first operating mode to the second operating mode before the current TXOP starts.
  • the first device may send the seventh frame to the second device based on OM2, and the seventh frame is used to indicate the switching time T.
  • the second device may send the eighth frame to the first device based on OM2 or OM3 to respond to the seventh frame.
  • the first device may send the first frame to the second device based on OM2 to initiate the OM negotiation.
  • the second device may respond to the first frame and send the eleventh frame to the first device based on OM2 or OM3.
  • the eleventh frame may be a management frame or an action frame, etc.
  • the first frame includes a first field, and the first field is an OM control field or an extended OM control field.
  • the extended OM control field includes an operating mode switching duration indication subfield.
  • the first device completes the operating mode switching before the TXOP, and in the current TXOP, optionally, the first device can send an RTS frame based on OM1, and the second device can send a CTS frame based on OM1 for data interaction.
  • the first device After a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS), the first device starts to periodically send data to the second device based on OM1, and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM1 to indicate that the data has been received until the current TXOP ends.
  • SIFS inter-frame interval
  • the first device completes the operating mode switching before the current TXOP, and uses the switched operating mode for data transmission in the current TXOP, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • the size of the serial number of the above-mentioned processes does not mean the order of execution.
  • the execution order of each process should be determined by its function and internal logic, and should not constitute any limitation on the implementation process of the embodiment of this application.
  • the first device can actively initiate OM negotiation to the second device.
  • the first device can actively initiate OM negotiation to the first device based on the received fifth frame, thereby improving the flexibility of the operation mode switching negotiation, improving the timeliness of the operation mode switching of the first device, and reducing the delay of the operation mode switching.
  • FIG. 16 is a flow chart of another communication method provided by an embodiment of the present application. As shown in Figure 16, the communication method includes but is not limited to the following steps, wherein steps S1601, S1602 and S1607 are optional steps.
  • a first device sends a seventh frame to a second device, which is used to indicate a switching time when the first device switches from a first operating mode to a second operating mode.
  • the second device receives the seventh frame from the first device.
  • S1602 The second device sends an eighth frame to the first device in response to the seventh frame.
  • the first device receives the eighth frame from the second device.
  • steps S1601-S1602 can refer to the above steps S501-S502, which will not be repeated here.
  • the second device generates a second frame including a second field, where the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend parameters for the operation mode negotiation.
  • the second device sends a second frame to the first device.
  • the first device receives the second frame from the second device.
  • steps S1603-S1604 can refer to the above steps S503-S504, which will not be repeated here.
  • S1605 The first device sends a sixth frame to the second device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the second device receives the sixth frame from the first device.
  • the sixth frame may be understood as a CTS frame that does not include the first field, ie, a regular CTS frame, which is used to request a response to the second frame.
  • S1606 During a period (switch duration) when the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode, data is transmitted between the first device and the second device.
  • step S1606 can refer to the above step S507 and will not be described in detail here.
  • the first device sends a third frame to the second device indicating that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the second device receives the third frame from the first device.
  • the third frame may be sent to the second device.
  • the first device may select the original signal bandwidth or the switched signal bandwidth to send the third frame to the second device.
  • S1608 Data is transmitted between the first device and the second device.
  • the second device may send data to the first device.
  • the second device may send data to the first device in any of the following ways:
  • Method 1 After receiving the third frame from the first device, the second device sends data to the first device.
  • a possible implementation method is that after receiving the third frame, the second device can immediately send data to the first device according to the switched operating mode; a possible implementation method is that after receiving the third frame, the second device sends data to the first device after a certain inter-frame space (SIFS) according to the switched operating mode; a possible implementation method is that after the second device receives the third frame, the first device sends a request message for requesting to send data to the second device, and after the second device receives the request message, it sends data to the first device according to the switched operating mode; a possible implementation method is that after the second device receives the third frame, the first device sends a request frame (requestframe) for requesting to send data to the second device, and after the second device receives the request frame, it replies to the first device with a response frame (responseframe) in response to the request frame, and then sends data to the first device according to the switched operating mode; a possible implementation method is that if the second device does not receive the third frame and/
  • Method 2 After the second device receives the sixth frame from the first device, it sends data to the first device.
  • a possible implementation method is that after the second device receives the sixth frame, it immediately sends data to the first device according to the switched operation mode;
  • a possible implementation method is that after the second device receives the sixth frame, it sends data to the first device after a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS) according to the switched operation mode;
  • a possible implementation method is that after the second device receives the sixth frame, it sends data to the first device after a certain preset time (for example, the time agreed between the first device and the second device for the first device to switch the operation mode) according to the switched operation mode.
  • SIFS inter-frame interval
  • S1609 The second device sends a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the current TXOP.
  • the first device receives the fourth frame from the second device.
  • step S1609 can refer to the above-mentioned step S510, which will not be repeated here.
  • FIG. 17 is a schematic diagram of an exemplary description of a communication method provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the second frame is an OMI RTS frame
  • the third frame is an OMI ACK frame
  • the fourth frame is a CF-end frame
  • the sixth frame is a CTS frame
  • the second device sends data to the first device as an example for exemplary description:
  • the second device may send an OMI RTS frame to the first device based on the target operation mode OM1 to initiate OM negotiation, and the OMI RTS may indicate to the first device that the target operation mode type is OM1, i.e., requesting the first device to switch from the first operation mode OM2 to the second operation mode OM1.
  • the OMI RTS frame includes a second field, which is an OM control field or an extended OM control field.
  • the first device receives the OMI RTS frame and sends a CTS frame to the second device based on OM2, and the CTS frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the first device After the first device sends a CTS frame to the second device, it starts to switch from the first operation mode to the second operation mode after a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS). After the operation mode switching is completed, the first device can send an OMI ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 (i.e., based on the operation mode type before switching or the operation mode type after switching) to indicate that the operation mode has been switched, so as to notify the second device to send data.
  • the second device can send data to the first device based on OM1 after a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS), and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM4 to indicate that the data has been received.
  • SIFS inter-frame interval
  • the second device can send data to the first device based on OM3, and the first device sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM2 to indicate that the data has been received or to indicate whether to resend the data.
  • the first device and the second device send and receive data, which can improve the utilization rate of the air interface and avoid the problem of other users occupying the channel due to the long switching time.
  • the second device can also send a CF-end frame to the first device based on OM1 to end the current TXOP in advance. It can be seen from FIG. 17 that TXOP2 after the operation mode of the first device is switched is shorter than TXOP1 before the operation mode is switched, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • the first device and the second device can negotiate the switching time of the first device switching from the first operation mode to the second operation mode outside the current TXOP.
  • the specific implementation method can refer to the description of Figure 13 above, which will not be repeated here.
  • the size of the serial number of the above-mentioned processes does not mean the order of execution.
  • the execution order of each process should be determined by its function and internal logic, and should not constitute any limitation on the implementation process of the embodiment of this application.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation with the first device.
  • the second device can actively initiate OM negotiation with the first device based on information such as the amount of data to be transmitted, latency requirements, and channel status of its own business.
  • the first device can respond to the OM negotiation and send the sixth frame to the second device, thereby improving the flexibility of the operation mode switching negotiation.
  • Figure 18 is a schematic diagram of an exemplary description of a communication method in a multi-user scenario provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • a second device and multiple first devices may be included (Figure 18 only shows three first devices for exemplary description, that is, multiple first devices include first device 1, first device 2 and first device 3.
  • the first device 3 may be an original device (legacy) and does not support switching the operating mode within the current TXOP).
  • the first frame can be an OMI CTS frame
  • the second frame is an OMI MU RTS frame
  • the third frame is an OMI ACK frame
  • the fourth frame is a CF-end frame as an example for exemplary description:
  • the operation mode types may include OM1, OM2, OM3, OM4, OM12 (OFDMA), OM22 (OFDMA) and OM32 (OFDMA).
  • the channel bandwidth and signal bandwidth corresponding to OM1 are BW11 and SW11 respectively
  • the channel bandwidth and signal bandwidth corresponding to OM21 are BW21 and SW21 respectively
  • the channel bandwidth and signal bandwidth corresponding to OM3 are BW31 and SW31 respectively
  • the channel bandwidth and signal bandwidth corresponding to OM4 are BW41 and SW41 respectively
  • the channel bandwidth and signal bandwidth corresponding to OM12 (OFDMA) are BW11 and SW12 respectively
  • the channel bandwidth and signal bandwidth corresponding to OM22 (OFDMA) are BW11 and SW22 respectively
  • the channel bandwidth and signal bandwidth corresponding to OM32 (OFDMA) are BW11 and SW32 respectively.
  • the second device can actively initiate the operation mode negotiation. Specifically, in the current TXOP, the second device can send the ninth frame to multiple first devices based on OM11, for example, the ninth frame is a multi-user (mutilateuser, MU) RTS frame, and multiple first devices can send the tenth frame to the second device based on OM21, OM31 and OM41, for example, the tenth frame is a CTS frame.
  • the second device can send an OMI MU RTS frame to the first device 1 and the first device 2 based on OM11 to initiate OM negotiation.
  • SIFS inter-frame interval
  • the OMI MU RTS frame can indicate to the first device 1 and the first device 2 that the target operation mode type is OM22 and OM32, that is, requesting the first device 1 to switch from the first operation mode OM21 to the second operation mode OM22, and requesting the first device 2 to switch from the first operation mode OM31 to the second operation mode OM32.
  • the OMI MU RTS frame includes a second field, and the second field is an OM control field or an extended OM control field.
  • the first device 1 and the first device 2 can reply the OMI CTS frame to the second device. After a certain inter-frame space (SIFS), the first device 1 and the first device 2 start to switch the operation mode.
  • SIFS inter-frame space
  • the second device can send data to multiple first devices based on OM11, and the first device 1 sends an ACK frame table to the second device based on OM21. Indicates that data has been received or indicates whether to resend data, and the first device 2 sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM331 to indicate that data has been received or indicates whether to resend data.
  • the first device and the second device send and receive data, which can improve the utilization rate of the air interface and avoid the problem of other users occupying the channel due to the long switching time.
  • the first device 1 and the first device 2 can send OMI ACK frames to the second device based on OM21 and OM31 respectively to indicate that the operation mode has been switched, so as to notify the second device to send data.
  • the second device can send data to multiple first devices based on OM12 after a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS).
  • the first device 1 sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM22
  • the first device 2 sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM32
  • the first device 3 sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM41 to indicate that data has been received.
  • the second device can also send a CF-end frame to multiple first devices based on OM12 to end the current TXOP in advance.
  • TXOP2 of the plurality of first devices after the operation mode switching is shorter than TXOP1 before the operation mode switching, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • the first device may actively initiate operation mode negotiation. Specifically, in the current TXOP, the second device may send a MURTS frame to multiple first devices based on OM11, and multiple first devices may send CTS frames to the second device based on OM21, OM31, and OM41, respectively. After a certain inter-frame interval (SIFS), the first device 1 and the first device 2 may send an OMI CTS frame to the second device based on OM21 and OM31, respectively, to initiate OM negotiation and start switching from the first operation mode to the second operation mode.
  • SIFS inter-frame interval
  • the OMI CTS frame includes a first field, which is an OM control field or an extended OM control field, and the extended OM control field includes an operation mode switching duration indication subfield.
  • the second device may send data to multiple first devices based on OM11
  • the first device 1 may send an ACK frame to the second device based on OM21 to indicate that data has been received or to indicate whether to resend data
  • the first device 2 may send an ACK frame to the second device based on OM331 to indicate that data has been received or to indicate whether to resend data.
  • the first device and the second device transmit and receive data, which can improve air interface utilization and avoid the problem of other users occupying the channel due to a long switching time.
  • the first device 1 and the first device 2 can send an OMI ACK frame to the second device based on OM21 and OM31 respectively to indicate that the operation mode has been switched, so as to notify the second device to send data.
  • the second device can send data to multiple first devices based on OM12 within a certain inter-frame space (SIFS) after receiving the OMI ACK frame.
  • SIFS inter-frame space
  • the first device 1 and the second device 2 may not need to send an OMI ACK frame to the second device after the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the second device may send data to multiple first devices according to the duration indication of the operation mode switching indication in the extendedOM control field.
  • the second device sends data to multiple first devices, the first device 1 sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM22, the first device 2 sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM32, and the first device 3 sends an ACK frame to the second device based on OM41 to indicate that the data has been received.
  • the second device can also send a CF-end frame to multiple first devices based on OM12 to end the current TXOP in advance.
  • the TXOP2 of multiple first devices after the operation mode is switched is shorter than the TXOP1 before the operation mode is switched, thereby improving the efficiency of data transmission.
  • the first device and the second device can negotiate the switching time of the first device switching from the first operation mode to the second operation mode outside the current TXOP.
  • the specific implementation method can refer to the description of Figure 13 above, which will not be repeated here.
  • orthogonal frequency division multiple access can be used to exchange data with the second device.
  • the above content describes the method provided by the present application.
  • the embodiment of the present application also provides a corresponding device.
  • the embodiment of the present application can divide the functional modules of the communication device according to the above method example.
  • each functional module can be divided according to each function, or two or more functions can be integrated into one processing module.
  • the above integrated module can be implemented in the form of hardware or in the form of software functional modules. It should be noted that the division of modules in the embodiment of the present application is schematic and is only a logical function division. There may be other division methods in actual implementation.
  • FIG. 19 is a schematic diagram of the structure of a communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • the communication device can be a first device, or a module (for example, a chip or a processor) in the first device, or a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the first device.
  • the communication device 1900 at least includes: an establishment unit 1901, a switching unit 1902, a transceiver unit 1903, and a processing unit 1904; wherein:
  • An establishing unit 1901 is configured to establish a wireless communication link with a second device, wherein the first device operates in a first operating mode;
  • a switching unit 1902 configured to switch from the first operation mode to a second operation mode
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is used to communicate with the second device.
  • the switching unit 1902 switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode when a first condition is met, and the first condition includes one or more of the following: the first device changes from a listening state to a data transmission state; or the first device The amount of data to be transmitted between the first device and the second device increases from less than or equal to a first threshold to greater than the first threshold.
  • the first operating mode corresponds to a first bandwidth
  • the second operating mode corresponds to a second bandwidth
  • the second device operates in a third operation mode, and the third operation mode corresponds to a third bandwidth.
  • the first bandwidth is less than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the second bandwidth is less than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the switching unit 1902 switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode, specifically for: generating a first frame, the first frame including a first field, the first field including an operating mode parameter; sending the first frame to the second device; switching from the first operating mode to the second operating mode.
  • the first field includes an operating mode switch duration indication.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further used to receive a second frame from the second device, the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further used to send a seventh frame to the second device before the current TXOP, where the seventh frame is used to indicate a switching time when the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode;
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further configured to receive an eighth frame from the second device, where the eighth frame is used to respond to the seventh frame.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further used to receive a fifth frame from the second device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 sends a first frame to the second device, which is specifically used to: evaluate the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side based on the TXOP duration in the fifth frame, and when the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side is greater than or equal to a fourth threshold, send the first frame to the second device within the current TXOP.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 sends the first frame to the second device, specifically configured to: send the first frame to the second device in the current TXOP when the time indicated by the TXOP duration in the fifth frame exceeds a preset threshold.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further configured to send a sixth frame to the second device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further used to receive a ninth frame from the second device, where the ninth frame is used for the second device to transmit data to one or more first devices;
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further configured to send a tenth frame to the second device, where the tenth frame is used to respond to the ninth frame.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further configured to receive data from the second device during a period in which the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further configured to send a third frame to the second device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 sends a third frame to the second device, specifically for: when the operating mode switching duration indication in the first field is a first value, after completing the operating mode switching, sending the third frame to the second device.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 sends a third frame to the second device, specifically for: when the operating mode switching duration of the first device is greater than the time indicated by the operating mode switching duration in the first field, after completing the operating mode switching, sending the third frame to the second device.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 sends the third frame to the second device, specifically configured to: select an original signal bandwidth or a switched signal bandwidth to send the third frame to the second device.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is a request to send (RTS) frame or a trigger frame.
  • RTS request to send
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the fifth frame is a RTS frame.
  • the communication device further includes:
  • the processing unit 1904 is used to pre-store PHY layer module calibration data in different operation modes
  • the corresponding PHY layer module calibration data is selected according to the first field, and the PHY layer register is configured.
  • the processing unit 1904 pre-stores PHY layer module calibration data in different operation modes, specifically used to: pre-store PHY layer calibration data of a first bandwidth operation mode, where the first bandwidth is a bandwidth greater than or equal to a first threshold;
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further configured to transmit and receive signals using a signal bandwidth smaller than the first bandwidth after channel switching.
  • the transceiver unit 1903 is further configured to receive a fourth frame from the second device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the TXOP.
  • FIG. 20 is a schematic diagram of the structure of another communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • the communication device may be a second device, or a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the second device, or a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • the communication device 2000 at least includes: an establishment unit 2001, a transceiver unit 2002, and a processing unit 2003; wherein:
  • An establishing unit 2001 is configured to establish a wireless communication link with a first device, wherein the first device operates in a first operating mode;
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is used to communicate with the first device based on the second operating mode.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 communicates with the first device based on the second operating mode, and the first condition includes one or more of the following: the first device changes from a listening state to a data transmission state; or the amount of data to be transmitted between the first device and the second device changes from less than or equal to a first threshold to greater than the first threshold.
  • the first operating mode corresponds to a first bandwidth
  • the second operating mode corresponds to a second bandwidth
  • the second device operates in a third operating mode, and the third operating mode corresponds to a third bandwidth.
  • the first bandwidth is less than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the second bandwidth is less than or equal to the third bandwidth
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further configured to receive a first frame from the first device, where the first frame includes a first field, and the first field includes an operating mode parameter.
  • the first field includes an operating mode switch duration indication.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further used to send a second frame to the first device, the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 sends a second frame to the first device, specifically for: sending the second frame to the first device when the amount of data to be transmitted of the second device is greater than or equal to a second threshold or the required transmission time of the data to be transmitted is greater than or equal to a third threshold.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further configured to:
  • the seventh frame being used to indicate a switching time when the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode;
  • An eighth frame is sent to the first device, where the eighth frame is used to respond to the seventh frame.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further used to send a fifth frame to the first device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further configured to send a sixth frame to the first device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further configured to:
  • a tenth frame is received from the first device, where the tenth frame is used to respond to the ninth frame.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further configured to send data to the one or more first devices when a first frame is received from the one or more first devices or when a first frame is not received from the one or more first devices within a preset time.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further configured to send data to the first device during a period in which the first device switches from the first operating mode to the second operating mode.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further used to receive a third frame from the first device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further configured to send data to the first device after receiving the third frame from the first device.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further configured to send data to the first device after a time indicated by the operating mode switching duration when the operating mode switching duration in the first field indicates a second value.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the fifth frame is a RTS frame.
  • the transceiver unit 2002 is further configured to send a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the TXOP.
  • the communication device can be a first device, or a module (for example, a chip or a processor) in the first device, or a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the first device.
  • the communication device 2100 includes at least: a generation unit 2101, a transceiver unit 2102, and a processing unit 2103; wherein:
  • a generating unit 2101 is configured to generate a first frame, wherein the first frame includes a first field, and the first field includes an operation mode parameter;
  • the transceiver unit 2102 is configured to send the first frame to the second device.
  • the first field includes an operating mode switch duration indication.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the communication device 2100 further includes:
  • the transceiver unit 2102 is used to receive a second frame from the second device, where the second frame includes a second field, where the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and where the second field is used to recommend parameters for the operation mode negotiation.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the transceiver unit 2102 is further used to: receive a fifth frame from the second device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device;
  • the transceiver unit 2102 sends the first frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the amount of data to be transmitted on the second device side is evaluated according to the fifth frame, and when the TXOP is greater than or equal to a fourth threshold, the first frame is sent to the second device in the current TXOP.
  • the transceiver unit 2102 sends the first frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the first frame is sent to the second device in the current TXOP.
  • the transceiver unit 2102 is further configured to: send a third frame to the second device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the transceiver unit 2102 sends the third frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the third frame is sent to the second device.
  • the transceiver unit 2102 sends the third frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the third frame is sent to the second device after the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the transceiver unit 2102 sends the third frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the fifth frame is a RTS frame.
  • the communication device 2100 further includes:
  • the processing unit 2103 is used to pre-store PHY layer module calibration data in different operation modes
  • the processing unit 2103 is further configured to select corresponding PHY layer module calibration data according to the first field and configure the PHY layer register.
  • the processing unit 2103 pre-stores PHY layer module calibration data in different operation modes, specifically for: pre-storing PHY layer calibration data of a first bandwidth operation mode, where the first bandwidth is a bandwidth greater than or equal to a first threshold;
  • the transceiver unit 2102 is further configured to transmit and receive signals using a signal bandwidth smaller than the first bandwidth after channel switching.
  • the transceiver unit 2102 is further configured to receive a fourth frame from the second device, wherein the fourth frame is configured to indicate TXOP ends.
  • FIG 22 is a schematic diagram of the structure of another communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • the communication device can be a second device, or a module (for example, a chip or a processor) in the second device, or a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • the communication device 2200 includes at least: a receiving unit 2201, a generating unit 2202, and a sending unit 2203; wherein:
  • the receiving unit 2201 is configured to receive a first frame from a first device, where the first frame includes a first field, and the first field includes an operating mode parameter.
  • the first field includes an operating mode switch duration indication.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the communication device 2200 further includes:
  • a generating unit 2202 is configured to generate a second frame, wherein the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate an operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend an operation mode parameter;
  • the sending unit 2203 is configured to send the second frame to the first device.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the sending unit 2203 sends the second frame to the first device, specifically configured to:
  • the second frame is sent to the first device.
  • the sending unit 2203 is further used to: send a fifth frame to the first device, where the fifth frame is used to request the second device to transmit data to the first device.
  • the receiving unit 2201 is further configured to: receive a third frame from the first device, wherein the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the sending unit 2203 is further configured to: after receiving the third frame from the first device, send data to the first device.
  • the sending unit 2203 is further configured to: when the operation mode switching duration indication in the first field is a second value, send data to the first device after the time indicated by the operation mode switching duration.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the fifth frame is a RTS frame.
  • the sending unit 2203 is further used to: send a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the current TXOP.
  • FIG 23 is a schematic diagram of the structure of another communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • the communication device can be a first device, or a module (for example, a chip or a processor) in the first device, or a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the first device.
  • the communication device 2300 at least includes: a receiving unit 2301, a generating unit 2302, and a sending unit 2303; wherein:
  • the receiving unit 2301 is used to receive a second frame from a second device, where the second frame includes a second field, where the second frame is used to initiate operation mode negotiation, and where the second field is used to recommend operation mode parameters.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the communication device 2300 further includes:
  • a generating unit 2302 is configured to generate a first frame, wherein the first frame includes a first field, and the first field includes an operation mode parameter;
  • the sending unit 2303 is configured to send the first frame to the second device.
  • the first field includes an operating mode switch duration indication.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the sending unit 2303 is further configured to send a sixth frame to the second device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the sending unit 2303 is further configured to send a third frame to the second device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the sending unit 2303 sends the third frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the third frame is sent to the second device.
  • the sending unit 2303 sends the third frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the third frame is sent to the second device after the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the sending unit 2303 sends the third frame to the second device, specifically configured to:
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the sixth frame is a CTS frame.
  • the receiving unit 2301 is further configured to receive a fourth frame from the second device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the TXOP.
  • FIG 24 is a schematic diagram of the structure of another communication device provided in an embodiment of the present application.
  • the communication device can be a second device, or a module (for example, a chip or a processor) in the second device, or a logic module or software that can implement all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • the communication device 2400 at least includes: a generating unit 2401, a sending unit 2402, and a receiving unit 2403; wherein:
  • a generating unit 2401 is configured to generate a second frame, wherein the second frame includes a second field, the second frame is used to initiate an operation mode negotiation, and the second field is used to recommend an operation mode parameter;
  • the sending unit 2402 is configured to send the second frame to the first device.
  • the second field includes an operation mode recommendation indication and/or an operation mode negotiation indication.
  • the sending unit 2402 sends the second frame to the first device, specifically configured to:
  • the second frame is sent to the first device.
  • the communication device 2400 further includes:
  • the receiving unit 2403 is configured to receive a first frame from the first device, where the first frame includes a first field, and the first field includes an operating mode parameter.
  • the first field includes an operating mode switch duration indication.
  • the first field also includes a signal bandwidth.
  • the receiving unit 2403 is further configured to receive a sixth frame from the first device, where the sixth frame is used to respond to the second frame.
  • the receiving unit 2403 is further configured to receive a third frame from the first device, where the third frame is used to indicate that the operation mode switching is completed.
  • the sending unit 2402 is further configured to send data to the first device after receiving the third frame from the first device.
  • the sending unit 2402 is further configured to send data to the first device after the time indicated by the operating mode switching duration when the operating mode switching duration in the first field indicates a second value.
  • the sending unit 2402 is further configured to send data to the first device after receiving the sixth frame from the first device.
  • the first frame is a CTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the second frame is an RTS frame or a trigger frame.
  • the third frame is an ACK frame.
  • the sixth frame is a CTS frame.
  • the sending unit 2402 is further configured to send a fourth frame to the first device, where the fourth frame is used to indicate the end of the TXOP.
  • the communication device 2500 may include one or more processors 2501, which may also be referred to as a processing unit, and may implement certain control functions.
  • Processor 2501 may be a general-purpose processor or a dedicated processor, etc.
  • it may be a baseband processor or a central processing unit.
  • the baseband processor may be used to process communication protocols and communication data
  • the central processing unit may be used to control a communication device (such as a base station, a baseband chip, a terminal, a terminal chip, a DU or a CU, etc.), execute software programs, and process data of software programs.
  • the processor 2501 may also store instructions 2503, and the instructions 2503 can be executed by the processor so that the communication device 2500 executes the method described in the above method embodiment.
  • the processor 2501 may include a transceiver unit for implementing the receiving and sending functions.
  • the transceiver unit may be a transceiver circuit, or an interface, or an interface circuit, or a communication interface.
  • the transceiver circuit, interface, or interface circuit for implementing the receiving and sending functions may be separate or integrated.
  • the above-mentioned transceiver circuit, interface, or interface circuit may be used for reading and writing code/data, or the above-mentioned transceiver circuit, interface, or interface circuit may be used for transmitting or delivering signals.
  • the communication device 2500 may include a circuit that can implement the functions of sending, receiving, or communicating in the aforementioned method embodiments.
  • the communication device 2500 may include one or more memories 2502, on which instructions 2504 may be stored, and the instructions 2504 may be executed on the processor, so that the communication device 2500 performs the method described in the above method embodiment.
  • data may also be stored in the memory.
  • instructions and/or data may also be stored in the processor.
  • the processor and memory may be provided separately or integrated together. For example, the corresponding relationship described in the above method embodiment may be stored in a memory or in a processor.
  • the communication device 2500 may further include a transceiver 2505 and/or an antenna 2506.
  • the processor 2501 may be referred to as a processing unit, which controls the communication device 2500.
  • the transceiver 2505 may be referred to as a transceiver unit, a transceiver, a transceiver circuit, a transceiver device or a transceiver module, etc., which is used to implement a transceiver function.
  • the communication device 2500 in the embodiment of the present application can be used to execute the method described in Figures 4 to 18 in the embodiment of the present application.
  • the communication device 2500 can be applied to the first device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the first device, or to a logic module or software that can realize all or part of the functions of the first device.
  • the processor 2501 is used to perform the operations performed by the establishment unit 1901, the switching unit 1902, and the processing unit 1904 in the above-mentioned embodiment, or to perform the operations performed by the generation unit 2101 and the processing unit 2103 in the above-mentioned embodiment, or to perform the operations performed by the generation unit 2302 in the above-mentioned embodiment
  • the transceiver 2505 is used to perform the operations performed by the transceiver unit 1903 in the above-mentioned embodiment, or to perform the operations performed by the transceiver unit 2102 in the above-mentioned embodiment, or to perform the operations performed by the receiving unit 2301 and the sending unit 2303 in the above-mentioned embodiment, and the
  • the communication device 2500 can be applied to a second device, or to a module (e.g., a chip or a processor) in the second device, or to a logic module or software that can realize all or part of the functions of the second device.
  • a module e.g., a chip or a processor
  • the processor 2501 is used to execute the establishment unit 2001 and the processing unit 2003 in the above-mentioned embodiment, or to execute the operation performed by the generation unit 2202 in the above-mentioned embodiment, or to execute the operation performed by the generation unit 2401 in the above-mentioned embodiment
  • the transceiver 2505 is used to execute the operation performed by the transceiver unit 2002 in the above-mentioned embodiment, or to execute the operation performed by the receiving unit 2201 and the sending unit 2203 in the above-mentioned embodiment, or to execute the operation performed by the sending unit 2402 and the receiving unit 2403 in the above-mentioned embodiment
  • the transceiver 2505 is also used to send information to other communication devices outside the communication device.
  • the above-mentioned second device or the module in the second device can also be used to execute the various methods executed by the second device in the above-mentioned method embodiments of Figures 4 to 18, which will not be repeated.
  • the processor and transceiver described in the present application can be implemented in an integrated circuit (IC), an analog IC, a radio frequency interface chip (RFIC), a mixed signal IC, an application specific integrated circuit (ASIC), a printed circuit board (PCB), an electronic device, etc.
  • the processor and transceiver can also be manufactured using various IC process technologies, such as complementary metal oxide semiconductor (CMOS), N-type metal Oxide semiconductor (nMetal-oxide-semiconductor, NMOS), P-type metal oxide semiconductor (positive channel metal oxide semiconductor, PMOS), bipolar junction transistor (Bipolar Junction Transistor, BJT), bipolar CMOS (BiCMOS), silicon germanium (SiGe), gallium arsenide (GaAs), etc.
  • CMOS complementary metal oxide semiconductor
  • NMOS N-type metal Oxide semiconductor
  • PMOS bipolar junction transistor
  • BiCMOS bipolar CMOS
  • SiGe silicon germanium
  • GaAs gallium arsenide
  • the device described in the above embodiment may be the first device or the second device, but the scope of the device described in the present application is not limited thereto, and the structure of the device may not be limited by FIG. 25.
  • the device may be an independent device or may be part of a larger device.
  • the device may be:
  • the IC set may also include a storage component for storing data and/or instructions;
  • ASIC such as modem (MSM)
  • An embodiment of the present application also provides a computer-readable storage medium having a computer program stored thereon.
  • the program is executed by a processor, the process related to the first device in the communication method provided in the above method embodiment can be implemented.
  • An embodiment of the present application also provides a computer-readable storage medium on which a computer program is stored.
  • the program When the program is executed by a processor, it can implement the process related to the second device in the communication method provided in the above method embodiment.
  • the embodiment of the present application also provides a computer program product, which, when executed on a computer or processor, enables the computer or processor to perform one or more steps in any of the above communication methods. If the components of the above-mentioned devices are implemented in the form of software functional units and sold or used as independent products, they can be stored in the computer-readable storage medium.
  • the embodiment of the present application also provides a chip system, including at least one processor and a communication interface, wherein the communication interface and the at least one processor are interconnected via a line, and the at least one processor is used to run a computer program or instruction to execute part or all of the steps of any one of the method embodiments corresponding to Figures 4 to 18 above.
  • the chip system can be composed of chips, or it can include chips and other discrete devices.
  • An embodiment of the present application also discloses a communication system, which includes a first device and a second device.
  • a communication system which includes a first device and a second device.
  • FIGS. 4 to 18 For a specific description, reference may be made to the communication method shown in FIGS. 4 to 18 .
  • the memory mentioned in the embodiments of the present application may be a volatile memory or a non-volatile memory, or may include both volatile and non-volatile memories.
  • the non-volatile memory may be a hard disk drive (HDD), a solid-state drive (SSD), a read-only memory (ROM), a programmable read-only memory (PROM), an erasable programmable read-only memory (EPROM), an electrically erasable programmable read-only memory (EEPROM), or a flash memory.
  • the volatile memory may be a random access memory (RAM), which is used as an external cache.
  • RAM random access memory
  • DRAM dynamic random access memory
  • SDRAM synchronous dynamic random access memory
  • DDR SDRAM double data rate synchronous dynamic random access memory
  • ESDRAM enhanced synchronous dynamic random access memory
  • SLDRAM synchronous link dynamic random access memory
  • DR RAM direct RAM bus RAM
  • Memory is any other medium that can be used to carry or store desired program code in the form of instructions or data structures and can be accessed by a computer, but is not limited to this.
  • the memory in the embodiments of the present application can also be a circuit or any other device that can realize a storage function, used to store program instructions and/or data.
  • processors mentioned in the embodiments of the present application may be a central processing unit (CPU), or other general-purpose processors, digital signal processors (DSP), application-specific integrated circuits (ASIC), field programmable gate arrays (FPGA) or other programmable logic devices, discrete gate or transistor logic devices, discrete hardware components, etc.
  • DSP digital signal processors
  • ASIC application-specific integrated circuits
  • FPGA field programmable gate arrays
  • a general-purpose processor may be a microprocessor or the processor may also be any conventional processor, etc.
  • processor is a general-purpose processor, DSP, ASIC, FPGA or other programmable logic device, discrete gate or transistor logic device, discrete hardware component, the memory (storage module) is integrated in the processor.
  • memory described herein is intended to include, without being limited to, these and any other suitable types of memory.
  • the size of the sequence number of each process does not mean the order of execution.
  • the execution order should be determined by its functions and internal logic, and should not constitute any limitation on the implementation process of the embodiments of the present application.
  • the disclosed systems, devices and methods can be implemented in other ways.
  • the device embodiments described above are only schematic.
  • the division of the units is only a logical function division. There may be other division methods in actual implementation, such as multiple units or components can be combined or integrated into another system, or some features can be ignored or not executed.
  • Another point is that the mutual coupling or direct coupling or communication connection shown or discussed can be through some interfaces, indirect coupling or communication connection of devices or units, which can be electrical, mechanical or other forms.
  • the units described as separate components may or may not be physically separated, and the components shown as units may or may not be physical units, that is, they may be located in one place or distributed on multiple network units. Some or all of the units may be selected according to actual needs to achieve the purpose of the solution of this embodiment.
  • each functional unit in each embodiment of the present application may be integrated into one processing unit, or each unit may exist physically separately, or two or more units may be integrated into one unit.
  • the functions are implemented in the form of software functional units and sold or used as independent products, they can be stored in a computer-readable storage medium.
  • the technical solution of the present application or the part that contributes to the technology or the part of the technical solution, can be embodied in the form of a software product, which is stored in a storage medium and includes several instructions for a computer device (which can be a personal computer, server, or network device, etc.) to perform all or part of the steps of the method described in each embodiment of the present application.
  • the aforementioned storage medium includes: various media that can store program codes, such as USB flash drives, mobile hard drives, ROM, RAM, magnetic disks, or optical disks.
  • modules/units in the device of the embodiment of the present application can be combined, divided and deleted according to actual needs.

Landscapes

  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
  • Signal Processing (AREA)
  • Mobile Radio Communication Systems (AREA)

Abstract

本申请涉及通信领域,尤其涉及一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质,可以适用于感知sensing系统,还可以适用于符合IEEE 802.11系统标准,例如802.11bf、802.11a/b/g、802.11n、802.11ac、802.11ax,或其下一代,例如802.11be或更下一代的标准的系统,或者基于超带宽UWB的无线个人局域网系统等。本申请提供了一种通信方法及装置,方法包括:第一设备和第二设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,与所述第二设备进行通信。通过本申请实施例的方法,可以提高业务传输的效率。

Description

一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质
本申请要求在2022年11月26日提交中国国家知识产权局、申请号为202211495298.9的中国专利申请的优先权,发明名称为“一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质”的中国专利申请的优先权,其全部内容通过引用结合在本申请中。
技术领域
本申请涉及无线通信技术领域,尤其涉及一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质。
背景技术
为了提高无线保真(wireless fidelity,WiFi)设备的灵活性,802.11ax标准引入了运行模式指示(operatingmodeindication,OMI)机制。在OMI机制中,STA为OMI发起方,接入点(access point,AP)为OMI响应方,STA可以向AP发送包含运行模式(operatingmode,OM)控制字段的数据帧或控制帧,实现STA动态切换单用户/多用户运行模式、信道带宽、最大接收空间流数等。现有OMI机制中仅支持STA发起OM协商导致运行模式切换的灵活性较差,业务传输的效率较低。因此,如何提高业务传输的效率是亟待解决的问题。
发明内容
本申请实施例提供了一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质,可以提高业务传输的效率。
第一方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信方法,该通信方法可以应用于第一设备,也可以应用于第一设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。下面以执行主体是第一设备为例进行描述。该通信方法包括:第一设备和第二设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,与所述第二设备进行通信。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,并与第二设备进行通信,通过第一设备的运行模式的切换,可以提高业务传输的效率。
一种可能的实现方式,在满足第一条件的情况下,所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,所述第一条件包括以下一项或多项:所述第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者所述第一设备与所述第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。
在本申请提供的方案中,在第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者第一设备与第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值等情况下,第一设备可以从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,从而可以提高业务传输的效率。
一种可能的实现方式,第一运行模式对应第一带宽,所述第二运行模式对应第二带宽。
在本申请提供的方案中,不同运行模式可以对应不同带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,第二设备工作在第三运行模式,所述第三运行模式对应第三带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽,所述第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式包括:所述第一设备生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧;所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以生成并向第二设备发送包含运行模式参数的第一帧,实现第一设备主动发起运行模式协商,或者通过第一帧响应第二设备发起的运行模式协商,从而可以提高运行模式切换的灵活性,进而提高业务传输的效率。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以主动向第一设备发起OM协商,例如第二设备可以根据自身业 务的待传输数据量、时延需求、信道状态等信息主动向第一设备发起OM协商,从而提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性。另外,当第二设备发起下行数据传输时,无需第一设备感知第二设备侧的传输的数据量,第一设备只需要响应来自第二设备的第二帧,就可以实现运行模式切换,从而可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:所述第一设备在当前传输机会(transmission opportunity,TXOP)前向所述第二设备发送第七帧,所述第七帧用于指示所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式的切换时间;所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的第八帧,所述第八帧用于响应所述第七帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以在TXOP前通过第七帧和第八帧协商好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间,在该场景下,第一设备在完成运行模式切换后,可以不用再发第三帧用于指示切换完成,节省信令开销,可以提高TXOP内的传输数据效率。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第一帧包括:
所述第一设备根据所述第五帧中的TXOP时长评估所述第二设备侧待传输数据的数据量,在所述第二设备侧待传输数据的数据量大于或等于第四阈值的情况下,所述第一设备在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备接收到来自第二设备的第五帧后,可以根据第五帧评估第二设备侧待传输的数据量,从而自主决策是否发起OM协商。第一设备可以通过主动向第二设备发起OM协商,实现运行模式切换,从而提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性,提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第一帧包括:
在所述第五帧中的TXOP时长指示的时间超过预设门限的情况下,所述第一设备在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以在一个TXOP内主动向第二设备发起OM协商,实现运行模式切换,从而可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备接收到来自第二设备的第二帧,根据第二帧完成运行模式切换后,可以向第二设备发送第六帧,例如CTS帧,用于请求第二设备向第一设备传输数据,从而可以实现高效的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的第九帧,所述第九帧用于所述第二设备向一个或多个第一设备传输数据;所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第十帧,所述第十帧用于响应所述第九帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,可以实现多用户场景下,第一设备或第二设备主动发起运行模式协商,实现运行模式切换,从而提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性,提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:在所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式期间,所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的数据。
在本申请提供的方案中,在第一设备的模式切换期间,第一设备和第二设备进行收发数据,可以提高空口利用率,并且可以避免由于切换时间较长而导致的其它用户抢占信道的问题。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备在运行模式切换完成后可以向第二设备发送第三帧,例如OMI ACK帧,用于指示运行模式切换完成,可以实现高效、可靠的业务传输,可以解决第一设备无法通知第二设备当前运行模式的切换状态或切换完成时间,避免第二设备提前下发数据而造成数据包频发重发、丢包等情况,导致吞吐量下降、传输时延增加的问题。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧包括:在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第一数值的情况下,所述第一设备在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述 第三帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,例如,当第一帧中的第一字段包括的运行模式切换持续时间指示子字段设置为0时,表示第一字段中不携带第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间,第一设备可以在完成运行模式切换后向第二设备发送第三帧,以通知第二设备下发数据,可以实现高效、可靠的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧包括:在所述第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间大于所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间的情况下,所述第一设备在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,对于不支持快速信道切换的第一设备,第一设备运行模式切换时间较长,无法采用第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间完成运行模式切换,第一设备可以在完成运行模式切换后向第二设备发送第三帧,指示已完成运行模式切换,以通知第二设备下发数据,可以实现高效、可靠的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧包括:所述第一设备选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向第二设备发送第三帧,可以减小第一设备侧的上行信号对邻近用户的同道干扰。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为允许发送(clear to send,CTS)帧或触发(trigger)帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为请求发送(requestto send,RTS)帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为确认(acknowledge,ACK)帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第五帧为RTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备预存不同运行模式下物理(physical,PHY)层模块校准数据;所述第一设备根据所述第一字段选择对应的PHY层模块校准数据,配置PHY层寄存器。
在本申请提供的方案中,通过预先存储不同运行模式的PHY层模块校准数据并根据第一字段的运行模式参数配置PHY层寄存器,可以减小运行模式切换的时间,降低时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据包括:所述第一设备预存第一带宽运行模式的PHY层校准数据,所述第一带宽为大于或等于第一阈值的带宽;该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备在信道切换后采用小于所述第一带宽的信号带宽收发信号。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以预存第一带宽运行模式的PHY层模块校准数据,从而可以简化实现的复杂度。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备向第一设备下发数据完后,可以发送第四帧提前结束当前TXOP,从而可以实现高效的业务传输。
第二方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信方法,该通信方法可以应用于第二设备,也可以应用于第二设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。下面以执行主体是第二设备为例进行描述。该通信方法包括:第二设备和第一设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;所述第二设备与基于第二运行模式的所述第一设备进行通信。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,并与第二设备进行通信,通过第二设备与切换后运行模式的第一设备通信,可以提高业务传输的效率。
应理解,第二方面的执行主体可以为第二设备,第二方面的具体内容与第一方面的内容对应,第二方面相应特征以及达到的有益效果可以参考第一方面的描述,为避免重复,此处适当省略详细描述。
一种可能的实现方式,在满足第一条件的情况下,所述第二设备与基于第二运行模式的所述第一设备进行通信,所述第一条件包括以下一项或多项:所述第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者所述第一设备与所述第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一运行模式对应第一带宽,所述第二运行模式对应第二带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二设备工作在第三运行模式,所述第三运行模式对应第三带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽,所述第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第二设备接收来自所述第一设备的第一帧,所述第一 帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第二帧包括:在所述第二设备的待传输数据量大于或等于第二阈值或待传输数据的所需传输时间大于或等于第三阈值的情况下,所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以根据自身业务的待传输数据量、时延需求、信道状态等信息主动向第一设备发起OM协商,提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性。另外,当第二设备发起下行数据传输时,无需第一设备感知第二设备侧的传输的数据量,第一设备只需要响应来自第二设备的第二帧,就可以实现运行模式切换,从而可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:第二设备在当前TXOP前接收来自第一设备的第七帧,所述第七帧用于指示所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式的切换时间;所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第八帧,所述第八帧用于响应所述第七帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第九帧,所述第九帧用于所述第二设备向一个或多个第一设备传输数据;所述第二设备接收来自所述第一设备的第十帧,所述第十帧用于响应所述第九帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:所述第二设备在接收到来自一个或多个第一设备的第一帧或者在预设时间内未接收到来自一个或多个第一设备的第一帧的情况下,向所述一个或多个第一设备发送数据。
在本申请提供的方案中,在多用户场景下,第一设备可以通过向第二设备发送第一帧主动发起运行模式协商,当第二设备接收到至少一个第一设备的第一帧或者在预设时间内未收到第一帧的情况下,第二设备仍可以基于原运行模式向第一设备下发数据,直到第一设备完成运行模式切换,第二设备可以基于切换后的运行模式向第一设备下发数据。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:在所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式期间,所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送数据。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第二设备接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第二设备接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第三帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以根据接收到第三帧确定向第一设备下发数据的时间,可以实现高效的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第二数值的情况下,所述第二设备在所述运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间后向所述第一设备下发数据。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以根据第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示,确定向第一设备下发数据的时间,可以实现高效的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为ACK帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第五帧为RTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
第三方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信方法,该通信方法可以应用于第一设备,也可以应用于第一设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。下面以执行主体是第一设备为例进行描述。该通信方法包括:第一设备生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;所述第一设备向第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以生成并向第二设备发送包含运行模式参数的第一帧,实现第一设备主动发起运行模式协商,或者通过第一帧响应第二设备发起的运行模式协商,从而可以提高运行模式切换的灵活性。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:
所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以主动向第一设备发起OM协商,例如第二设备可以根据自身业务的待传输数据量、时延需求、信道状态等信息主动向第一设备发起OM协商,从而提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性。另外,当第二设备发起下行数据传输时,无需第一设备感知第二设备侧的传输的数据量,第一设备只需要响应来自第二设备的第二帧,就可以实现运行模式切换,从而可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:
所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第一帧包括:
所述第一设备根据所述第五帧评估所述第二设备侧待传输的数据量,在所述第二设备侧待传输的数据量大于或等于第四阈值的情况下,所述第一设备在当前传输机会(transmission opportunity,TXOP)内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备接收到来自第二设备的第五帧后,可以根据第五帧评估第二设备侧待传输的数据量,从而自主决策是否发起OM协商。第一设备可以通过主动向第二设备发起OM协商,实现运行模式切换,从而提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性,提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第一帧包括:在第五帧中的TXOP时长(duration)指示的时间超过预设门限时,所述第一设备在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以在一个TXOP内主动向第二设备发起OM协商,实现运行模式切换,从而可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备在运行模式切换完成后可以向第二设备发送第三帧,例如OMI ACK帧,用于指示运行模式切换完成,可以实现高效、可靠的业务传输,可以解决第一设备无法通知第二设备当前运行模式的切换状态或切换完成时间,避免第二设备提前下发数据而造成数据包频发重发、丢包等情况,导致吞吐量下降、传输时延增加的问题。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧包括:在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第一数值的情况下,所述第一设备在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,例如,当第一帧中的第一字段包括的运行模式切换持续时间指示子字段设置为0时,表示第一字段中不携带第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间,第一设备可以在完成运行模式切换后向第二设备发送第三帧,以通知第二设备下发数据,可以实现高效、可靠的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧包括:在所述第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间大于所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间的情况下,所述第一设备在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,对于不支持快速信道切换的第一设备,第一设备运行模式切换时间较长,无 法采用第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间完成运行模式切换,第一设备可以在完成运行模式切换后向第二设备发送第三帧,指示已完成运行模式切换,以通知第二设备下发数据,可以实现高效、可靠的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧包括:所述第一设备选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向第二设备发送第三帧,可以减小第一设备侧的上行信号对邻近用户的同道干扰。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为允许发送(clear to send,CTS)帧或触发(trigger)帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为请求发送(requestto send,RTS)帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为确认(acknowledge,ACK)帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第五帧为RTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备预存不同运行模式下物理(physical,PHY)层模块校准数据;所述第一设备根据所述第一字段选择对应的PHY层模块校准数据,配置PHY层寄存器。
在本申请提供的方案中,通过预先存储不同运行模式的PHY层模块校准数据并根据第一字段的运行模式参数配置PHY层寄存器,可以减小运行模式切换的时间,降低时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据包括:所述第一设备预存第一带宽运行模式的PHY层校准数据,所述第一带宽为大于或等于第一阈值的带宽;该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备在信道切换后采用小于所述第一带宽的信号带宽收发信号。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以预存第一带宽运行模式的PHY层模块校准数据,从而可以简化实现的复杂度。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备向第一设备下发数据完后,可以发送第四帧提前结束当前TXOP,从而可以实现高效的业务传输。
第四方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信方法,该通信方法可以应用于第二设备,也可以应用于第二设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。下面以执行主体是第二设备为例进行描述。该通信方法包括:第二设备接收来自第一设备的第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以接收来自第一设备的包含运行模式参数的第一帧,实现第一设备主动发起运行模式协商,或者通过第一帧响应第二设备发起的运行模式协商,从而可以提高运行模式切换的灵活性。
应理解,第四方面的执行主体可以为第二设备,第二方面的具体内容与第三方面的内容对应,第四方面相应特征以及达到的有益效果可以参考第三方面的描述,为避免重复,此处适当省略详细描述。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:
所述第二设备生成第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数;
所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第二帧包括:
在所述第二设备的待传输数据量大于或等于第二阈值或待传输数据的所需传输时间大于或等于第三阈值的情况下,所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以根据自身业务的待传输数据量、时延需求、信道状态等信息主动向第一设备发起OM协商,提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性。另外,当第二设备发起下行数据传输时,无需第一设备感知第二设备侧的传输的数据量,第一设备只需要响应来自第二设备的第二帧,就可以实现运行模式切换,从而可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:
所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:
所述第二设备接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第二设备接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第三帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以根据接收到第三帧确定向第一设备下发数据的时间,可以实现高效的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第二数值的情况下,所述第二设备在所述运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间后向所述第一设备下发数据。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以根据第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示,确定向第一设备下发数据的时间,可以实现高效的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为ACK帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第五帧为RTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示当前TXOP结束。
第五方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信方法,该通信方法可以应用于第一设备,也可以应用于第一设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。下面以执行主体是第一设备为例进行描述。该通信方法包括:
第一设备接收来自第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
在本申请实施例中,第一设备可以接收来自第二设备的用于发起运行模式协商的第二帧,实现第二设备主动发起运行模式协商,从而可以提高运行模式切换的灵活性。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:所述第一设备生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在本申请实施例中,第一设备接收到来自第二设备的第二帧后,可以响应于第二帧,即响应于第二设备主动发起的OM协商,向第二设备发送第一帧,从而可以提高运行模式切换的灵活性。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:
所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备接收到来自第二设备的第二帧,可以向第二设备发送第六帧,例如CTS帧,用于请求第二设备向第一设备传输数据,从而可以实现高效的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备在根据第二帧完成运行模式切换后可以向第二设备发送第三帧,例如ACK帧,用于指示运行模式切换完成,可以实现高效、可靠的业务传输,可以解决第一设备无法通知第二设备当前运行模式的切换状态或切换完成时间,避免第二设备提前下发数据而造成数据包频发重发、丢包等情况,导致吞吐量下降、传输时延增加的问题。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧包括:在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第一值的情况下,所述第一设备在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,例如,当第一帧中的第一字段包括的运行模式切换持续时间指示子字段设置为0时,表示第一字段中不携带第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间,第一设备可以在完成运行模式切换后向第二设备发送第三帧,以通知第二设备下发数据,可以实现高效、可靠的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧包括:在所述第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间大于所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间的情况下,所述第一设备在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,对于不支持快速信道切换的第一设备,第一设备运行模式切换时间较长,无法采用第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间完成运行模式切换,第一设备可以在完成运行模式切换后向第二设备发送第三帧,指示已完成运行模式切换,以通知第二设备下发数据,可以实现高效、可靠的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧包括:所述第一设备选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第一设备可以选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向第二设备发送第三帧,可以减小第一设备侧的上行信号对邻近用户的同道干扰。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为ACK帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第六帧为CTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备向第一设备下发数据完后,可以发送第四帧提前结束当前TXOP,从而可以实现高效的业务传输。
第六方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信方法,该通信方法可以应用于第二设备,也可以应用于第二设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。下面以执行主体是第二设备为例进行描述。该通信方法包括:第二设备生成第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数;所述第二设备向第一设备发送所述第二帧。
在本申请实施例中,第二设备可以通过第二帧主动向第一设备发起运行模式协商,从而提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性。
应理解,第六方面的执行主体可以为第二设备,第六方面的具体内容与第五方面的内容对应,第六方面相应特征以及达到的有益效果可以参考第五方面的描述,为避免重复,此处适当省略详细描述。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第二帧包括:
在所述第二设备的待传输数据量大于或等于第二阈值或待传输数据的所需传输时间大于或等于第三阈值的情况下,所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以根据自身业务的待传输数据量、时延需求、信道状态等信息主动向第一设备发起OM协商,提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性。另外,当第二设备发起下行数据传输时,无需第一设备感知第二设备侧的传输的数据量,第一设备只需要响应来自第二设备的第二帧,就可以实现运行模式切换,从而可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:
所述第二设备接收来自所述第一设备的第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
在本申请实施例中,第一设备接收到来自第二设备的第二帧后,可以响应于第二帧,即响应于第二设备主动发起的OM协商,向第二设备发送第一帧,从而可以提高运行模式切换的灵活性。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述方法还包括:
所述第二设备接收来自所述第一设备的第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:
所述第二设备接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第二设备在接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第三帧后, 向所述第一设备下发数据。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以根据接收到第三帧确定向第一设备下发数据的时间,可以实现高效的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第二数值的情况下,所述第二设备在所述运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间后向所述第一设备下发数据。
在本申请提供的方案中,第二设备可以根据第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示,确定向第一设备下发数据的时间,可以实现高效的业务传输。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第二设备接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第六帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为ACK帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第六帧为CTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信方法还包括:所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
第七方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信装置。
该通信装置可以应用于第一设备,也可以应用于第一设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。有益效果可以参见第一方面的描述,此处不再赘述。所述通信装置具有实现上述第一方面方法实例中行为的功能。所述功能可以通过硬件实现,也可以通过硬件执行相应的软件实现。所述硬件或软件包括一个或多个与上述功能相对应的模块。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置包括:
建立单元,用于和第二设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;
切换单元,用于从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式;
收发单元,用于与所述第二设备进行通信。
一种可能的实现方式,在满足第一条件的情况下,所述切换单元从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,所述第一条件包括以下一项或多项:所述第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者所述第一设备与所述第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。
一种可能的实现方式,第一运行模式对应第一带宽,所述第二运行模式对应第二带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,第二设备工作在第三运行模式,所述第三运行模式对应第三带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽,所述第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述切换单元从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,具体用于:生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧;从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于在当前TXOP前向所述第二设备发送第七帧,所述第七帧用于指示所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式的切换时间;
所述收发单元,还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第八帧,所述第八帧用于响应所述第七帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元向所述第二设备发送第一帧,具体用于:根据所述第五帧中的TXOP时长评估所述第二设备侧待传输数据的数据量,在所述第二设备侧待传输数据的数据量大于或等于第四阈值的情况下,在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元向所述第二设备发送第一帧,具体用于:在所述第五帧中的TXOP 时长指示的时间超过预设门限的情况下,在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于向所述第二设备发送第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第九帧,所述第九帧用于所述第二设备向一个或多个第一设备传输数据;
所述收发单元还用于向所述第二设备发送第十帧,所述第十帧用于响应所述第九帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于在所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式期间,接收来自所述第二设备的数据。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第一数值的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:在所述第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间大于所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为请求发送RTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为ACK帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第五帧为RTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置还包括:
处理单元,用于预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据;
根据所述第一字段选择对应的PHY层模块校准数据,配置PHY层寄存器。
一种可能的实现方式,所述处理单元预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据,具体用于:预存第一带宽运行模式的PHY层校准数据,所述第一带宽为大于或等于第一阈值的带宽;
所述收发单元,还用于在信道切换后采用小于所述第一带宽的信号带宽收发信号。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
第八方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信装置。
该通信装置可以应用于第二设备,也可以应用于第二设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。有益效果可以参见第二方面的描述,此处不再赘述。所述通信装置具有实现上述第二方面方法实例中行为的功能。所述功能可以通过硬件实现,也可以通过硬件执行相应的软件实现。所述硬件或软件包括一个或多个与上述功能相对应的模块。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置包括:
建立单元,用于和第一设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;
收发单元,用于与基于第二运行模式的所述第一设备进行通信。
一种可能的实现方式,在满足第一条件的情况下,所述收发单元与基于第二运行模式的所述第一设备进行通信,所述第一条件包括以下一项或多项:所述第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者所述第一设备与所述第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一运行模式对应第一带宽,所述第二运行模式对应第二带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二设备工作在第三运行模式,所述第三运行模式对应第三带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽,所述第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于接收来自所述第一设备的第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于向所述第一设备发送第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元向所述第一设备发送第二帧,具体用于:在所述第二设备的待传输数据量大于或等于第二阈值或待传输数据的所需传输时间大于或等于第三阈值的情况下,向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于:
在当前TXOP前接收来自第一设备的第七帧,所述第七帧用于指示所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式的切换时间;
向所述第一设备发送第八帧,所述第八帧用于响应所述第七帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于向所述第一设备发送第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于向所述第一设备发送第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于:
向所述第一设备发送第九帧,所述第九帧用于所述第二设备向一个或多个第一设备传输数据;
接收来自所述第一设备的第十帧,所述第十帧用于响应所述第九帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于在接收到来自一个或多个第一设备的第一帧或者在预设时间内未接收到来自一个或多个第一设备的第一帧的情况下,向所述一个或多个第一设备发送数据。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于在所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式期间,向所述第一设备发送数据。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第三帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第二数值的情况下,在所述运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间后向所述第一设备下发数据。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为ACK帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第五帧为RTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述收发单元还用于向所述第一设备发送第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
第九方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信装置。
该通信装置可以应用于第一设备,也可以应用于第一设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。有益效果可以参见第三方面的描述,此处不再赘述。所述通信装置具有实现上述第三方面方法实例中行为的功能。所述功能可以通过硬件实现,也可以通过硬件执行相应的软件实现。所述硬件或软件包括一个或多个与上述功能相对应的模块。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置包括:
生成单元,用于生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;
收发单元,用于向第二设备发送所述第一帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置还包括:
收发单元,用于接收来自所述第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,收发单元还用于:接收来自所述第二设备的第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述 第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据;
收发单元向所述第二设备发送第一帧,具体用于:
根据所述第五帧评估所述第二设备侧待传输的数据量,在TXOP大于或等于第四阈值的情况下,在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
一种可能的实现方式,收发单元向所述第二设备发送第一帧,具体用于:
在第五帧中的TXOP时长(duration)指示的时间超过预设门限时,在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
一种可能的实现方式,收发单元还用于:向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
一种可能的实现方式,收发单元向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第一值的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
一种可能的实现方式,收发单元向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
在所述第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间大于所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
一种可能的实现方式,收发单元向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为ACK帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第五帧为RTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置还包括:
处理单元用于预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据;
处理单元,还用于根据所述第一字段选择对应的PHY层模块校准数据,配置PHY层寄存器。
一种可能的实现方式,处理单元预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据,具体用于:预存第一带宽运行模式的PHY层校准数据,所述第一带宽为大于或等于第一阈值的带宽;
收发单元,还用于在信道切换后采用小于所述第一带宽的信号带宽收发信号。
一种可能的实现方式,收发单元,还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
第十方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信装置。
该通信装置可以应用于第二设备,也可以应用于第二设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。有益效果可以参见第四方面的描述,此处不再赘述。所述通信装置具有实现上述第四方面方法实例中行为的功能。所述功能可以通过硬件实现,也可以通过硬件执行相应的软件实现。所述硬件或软件包括一个或多个与上述功能相对应的模块。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置包括:
接收单元,用于接收来自第一设备的第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置还包括:
生成单元,用于生成第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数;
发送单元,用于向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧,具体用于:
在所述第二设备的待传输数据量大于或等于第二阈值或待传输数据的所需传输时间大于或等于第三阈值的情况下,向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元还用于:向所述第一设备发送第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二 设备向所述第一设备传输数据。
一种可能的实现方式,接收单元还用于:接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元还用于:接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第三帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元还用于:在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第二数值的情况下,在所述运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间后向所述第一设备下发数据。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为ACK帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第五帧为RTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元还用于:向所述第一设备发送第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示当前TXOP结束。
第十一方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信装置。
该通信装置可以应用于第一设备,也可以应用于第一设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。有益效果可以参见第五方面的描述,此处不再赘述。所述通信装置具有实现上述第五方面方法实例中行为的功能。所述功能可以通过硬件实现,也可以通过硬件执行相应的软件实现。所述硬件或软件包括一个或多个与上述功能相对应的模块。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置包括:
接收单元,用于接收来自第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置还包括:
生成单元,用于生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;
发送单元,用于向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元还用于向所述第二设备发送第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元还用于向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第一值的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
在所述第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间大于所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为ACK帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第六帧为CTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,接收单元,还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
第十二方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信装置。
该通信装置可以应用于第二设备,也可以应用于第二设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。有益效果可以参见第六方面的描述,此处不再 赘述。所述通信装置具有实现上述第六方面方法实例中行为的功能。所述功能可以通过硬件实现,也可以通过硬件执行相应的软件实现。所述硬件或软件包括一个或多个与上述功能相对应的模块。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置包括:
生成单元,用于生成第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数;
发送单元,用于向第一设备发送所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元向第一设备发送所述第二帧,具体用于:
在所述第二设备的待传输数据量大于或等于第二阈值或待传输数据的所需传输时间大于或等于第三阈值的情况下,向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,该通信装置还包括:
接收单元,用于接收来自所述第一设备的第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
一种可能的实现方式,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
一种可能的实现方式,接收单元还用于接收来自所述第一设备的第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,接收单元还用于接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元,还用于在接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第三帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元,还用于在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第二数值的情况下,在所述运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间后向所述第一设备下发数据。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元,还用于接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第六帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
一种可能的实现方式,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第三帧为ACK帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第六帧为CTS帧。
一种可能的实现方式,发送单元还用于向所述第一设备发送第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
第十三方面,提供了一种通信装置,该通信装置可以为上述方法实施例中的第一设备,或者为设置在第一设备中的芯片或处理器。该通信装置可以包括处理器,处理器与存储器耦合,存储器用于存储程序或指令,当程序或指令被处理器执行时,使通信装置执行上述方法实施例中由第一设备、或第一设备中的芯片或处理器所执行的方法。
第十四方面,提供了一种通信装置,该通信装置可以为上述方法实施例中的第二设备,或者为设置在第二设备中的芯片或处理器。该通信装置可以包括处理器,处理器与存储器耦合,存储器用于存储程序或指令,当程序或指令被处理器执行时,使通信装置执行上述方法实施例中由第二设备、或第二设备中的芯片或处理器所执行的方法。
第十五方面,本申请实施例提供一种计算机可读存储介质,该计算机可读存储介质中存储有计算机程序或计算机指令,当该计算机程序或计算机指令在计算机上运行时,使得计算机执行上述第一方面或第一方面任一可能的实现方式、第二方面或第二方面任一可能的实现方式、第三方面或第三方面任一可能的实现方式、第四方面或第四方面任一可能的实现方式、第五方面或第五方面任一可能的实现方式、第六方面或第六方面任一可能的实现方式中的方法。
第十六方面,本申请实施例提供一种包含程序指令的计算机程序产品,当其在计算机上运行时,使得计算机执行上述第一方面或第一方面任一可能的实现方式、第二方面或第二方面任一可能的实现方式、第三方面或第三方面任一可能的实现方式、第四方面或第四方面任一可能的实现方式、第五方面或第五方面任一可能的实现方式、第六方面或第六方面任一可能的实现方式中的方法。
第十七方面,本申请实施例提供了芯片系统,该芯片系统包括处理器,用于实现上述各方法中的功能。 在一种可能的实现中,该芯片系统还可以包括存储器,用于保存程序指令和/或数据。该芯片系统可以由芯片构成,也可以包含芯片和其他分立器件。
第十八方面,本申请实施例提供一种通信系统,所述通信系统包括上述第一方面或第三方面所提供的第一设备,还可以包括上述第二方面或第四方面所提供的第二设备,第一设备用于执行上述第一方面或第一方面任一可能的实现方式、第三方面或第三方面任一可能的实现方式、第五方面或第五方面任一可能的实现方式中的方法,第二设备用于执行上述第二方面或第二方面任一可能的实现方式、第四方面或第四方面任一可能的实现方式、第六方面或第六方面任一可能的实现方式中的方法。
附图说明
为了更清楚地说明本申请实施例,下面将对实施例中所需要使用的附图作简单的介绍。显而易见地,对于本领域普通技术人员而言,在不付出创造性劳动的前提下,还可以根据这些附图获取其它的附图。
图1是本申请实施例提供的一种网络架构的示意图;
图2是本申请实施例提供的一种OMI机制的实现场景图;
图3(a)是本申请实施例提供的一种OM控制字段的结构示意图;
图3(b)是本申请实施例提供的一种在TXOP内传输数据的场景示意图;
图4是本申请实施例提供的一种通信方法的流程交互图;
图5是本申请实施例提供的另一种通信方法的流程交互图;
图6是本申请实施例提供的一种第二帧的结构示意图;
图7是本申请实施例提供的一种第二字段的结构示意图;
图8是本申请实施例提供的一种第一帧的结构示意图;
图9是本申请实施例提供的一种第一字段的结构示意图;
图10是本申请实施例提供的一种第三帧的结构示意图;
图11是本申请实施例提供的一种第三字段的结构示意图;
图12是第一设备发送第三帧的场景示意图;
图13是本申请实施例提供的一种通信方法示例性说明的示意图;
图14是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信方法的流程交互图;
图15是本申请实施例提供的另一种通信方法示例性说明的示意图;
图16是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信方法的流程交互图;
图17是本申请实施例提供的一种通信方法示例性说明的示意图;
图18是本申请实施例提供的在一种多用户场景下的通信方法示例性说明的示意图;
图19是本申请实施例提供的一种通信装置的结构示意图;
图20是本申请实施例提供的另一种通信装置的结构示意图;
图21是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信装置的结构示意图;
图22是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信装置的结构示意图;
图23是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信装置的结构示意图;
图24是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信装置的结构示意图;
图25是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信装置的结构示意图。
具体实施方式
下面将结合本申请实施例中的附图,对本申请实施例中的技术方案进行描述。其中,本申请实施例中的术语“系统”和“网络”可被互换使用。除非另有说明,“/”表示前后关联的对象是一种“或”的关系,例如,A/B可以表示A或B;本申请中的“和/或”仅仅是一种描述关联对象的关联关系,表示可以存在三种关系,例如,A和/或B,可以表示:单独存在A,同时存在A和B,单独存在B这三种情况,其中A,B可以是单数或者复数。并且,在本申请的描述中,除非另有说明,“多个”是指两个或多于两个。“以下至少一项(个)”或其类似表达,是指的这些项中的任意组合,包括单项(个)或复数项(个)的任意组合。例如,a,b,或c中的至少一项(个),可以表示:a,b,c,a-b,a-c,b-c,或a-b-c,其中a,b,c可以是一个,也可以是多个。另外,为了便于清楚描述本申请实施例的技术方案,在本申请的实施例中,采用了“第一”、“第二”等字样对网元和作用基本相同的相同项或相似项进行区分。本领域技术人员可以理解“第一”、“第二”等字样并不对数量和执行次序进行限定,并且“第一”、“第二”等字样也并不限定一定不同。
在本申请实施例中描述的参考“一个实施例”或“一些实施例”等意味着在本申请的一个或多个实施例中包括结合该实施例描述的特定特征、结构或特点。由此,在本说明书中的不同之处出现的语句“在一个实施例中”、“在一些实施例中”、“在其他一些实施例中”、“在另外一些实施例中”等不是必然都参考相同的实施例,而是意味着“一个或多个但不是所有的实施例”,除非是以其他方式另外特别强调。术语“包括”、“包含”、“具有”及它们的变形都意味着“包括但不限于”,除非是以其他方式另外特别强调。
以下的具体实施方式,对本申请的目标、技术方案和有益效果进行了进一步详细说明,应理解的是,以下仅为本申请的具体实施方式而已,并不用于限定本申请的保护范围,凡在本申请的技术方案的基础之上,所做的任何修改、等同替换、改进等,均应包括在本申请的保护范围之内。
应理解的,本申请实施例可以适用于感知sensing系统,还可以适用于符合IEEE 802.11系统标准,例如802.11bf、802.11a/b/g、802.11n、802.11ac、802.11ax,或其下一代,例如802.11be,Wi-Fi 7或EHT,或更下一代的标准的系统,例如Wi-Fi 8、UHR、Wi-Fi AI等802.11系列协议的无线局域网系统,或者基于超带宽UWB的无线个人局域网系统等,还可以适用于无线局域网(wireless local area network,WLAN)的场景。还或者本申请实施例也可以适用于物联网(internet of things,IoT)网络或车联网(vehicle to X,V2X)网络等无线局域网系统中。当然,本申请实施例还可以适用于其他可能的通信系统,例如,长期演进(long term evolution,LTE)系统、LTE频分双工(frequency division duplex,FDD)系统、LTE时分双工(time division duplex,TDD)、通用移动通信系统(universal mobile telecommunication system,UMTS)、全球互联微波接入(worldwide interoperability for microwave access,WiMAX)通信系统、以及未来的6G通信系统等。
下文以本申请实施例可以适用于WLAN的场景为例。应理解,WLAN从802.11a/g标准开始,历经802.11n、802.11ac、802.11ax和如今正在讨论的802.11be和Wi-Fi 8。其中802.11n也可称为高吞吐率(high throughput,HT);802.11ac也可称为非常高吞吐率(very high throughput,VHT);802.11ax也可称为高效(high efficient,HE)或者Wi-Fi 6;802.11be也可称为极高吞吐率(extremely high throughput,EHT)或者Wi-Fi 7,而对于HT之前的标准,如802.11a/b/g等统称叫做非高吞吐率(non-HT)。
请参阅图1,图1是本申请实施例提供的一种网络架构的示意图。如图1所示,以网络架构包括1个无线接入点AP和2个站点为例进行说明。与AP关联的STA,能够接收该AP发送的无线帧,也能够向该AP发送无线帧。另外,本申请实施例同样适用于AP与AP之间的通信,例如各个AP之间可通过分布式系统(distributed system,DS)相互通信,本申请实施例也适用于STA与STA之间的通信。应理解,图1中的AP和STA的数量仅是举例,还可以更多或者更少。
本申请实施例涉及到的STA是一种具有无线通信功能的装置,支持采用WLAN协议进行通信,具有与WLAN网络中的其他站点或接入点通信的能力。在WLAN系统中,站点可以称为非接入点站点(non-access point station,non-AP STA)。例如,STA是允许用户与AP通信进而与WLAN通信的任何用户通信设备,该装置可以为一个整机的设备,还可以是安装在整机设备中的芯片或处理系统等,安装这些芯片或处理系统的设备可以在芯片或处理系统的控制下,实现本申请实施例的方法和功能。例如,STA可以是各种具有无线通信功能的用户终端、用户装置,接入装置,订户站,订户单元,移动站,用户代理,用户装备或其他名称,其中,用户终端可以包括各种具有无线通信功能的手持设备、车载设备、可穿戴设备、计算设备或连接到无线调制解调器的其它处理设备,以及各种形式的用户设备(user equipment,UE),移动台(mobile station,MS),终端(terminal),终端设备(terminal equipment),便携式通信设备,手持机,便携式计算设备,娱乐设备,游戏设备或系统,全球定位系统设备或被配置为经由无线介质进行网络通信的任何其他合适的设备等。例如STA可以是路由器、交换机和网桥等,在此,为了描述方便,上面提到的设备统称为站点或STA。
本申请实施例涉及到的接入点(例如,AP)是一种具有无线通信功能的装置,支持采用WLAN协议进行通信,具有与WLAN网络中其他设备(例如站点或其他接入点)通信的功能,当然,还可以具有与其他设备通信的功能。在WLAN系统中,接入点可以称为接入点站点(AP STA)。该装置可以为一个整机的设备,还可以是安装在整机设备中的芯片或处理系统等,安装这些芯片或处理系统的设备可以在芯片或处理系统的控制下,实现本申请实施例的方法和功能。本申请实施例中的AP可以是为STA提供服务的装置,可以支持802.11系列协议。例如,AP可以为通信服务器、路由器、交换机、网桥等通信实体;AP可以包括各种形式的宏基站,微基站,中继站等,当然AP还可以为这些各种形式的设备中的芯片和处理 系统,从而实现本申请实施例的方法和功能。
本申请实施例所涉及到的AP和STA可以为适用于IEEE 802.11系统标准的AP和STA。AP是部署在无线通信网络中为其关联的STA提供无线通信功能的装置,该AP可用作该通信系统的中枢,通常为支持802.11系统标准的MAC和PHY的网络侧产品,例如可以为基站、路由器、网关、中继器,通信服务器,交换机或网桥等通信设备,其中,所述基站可以包括各种形式的宏基站,微基站,中继站等。在此,为了描述方便,上面提到的设备统称为AP。STA通常为支持802.11系统标准的介质访问控制(medium access control,MAC)和物理层(physical,PHY)的终端产品,例如手机、笔记本电脑等。
WLAN系统可以提供高速率低延时的传输,随着WLAN应用场景的不断演进,WLAN系统将会应用于更多场景或产业中,例如,应用于物联网产业,应用于车联网产业或应用于银行业,应用于企业办公,体育场馆展馆,音乐厅,酒店客房宿舍病房,教室,商超,广场,街道,生成车间和仓储等。当然,支持WLAN通信的设备(例如接入点或站点)可以是智慧城市中的传感器节点(例如智能水表,智能电表,智能空气检测节点),智慧家居中的智能设备(例如智能摄像头,投影仪,显示屏,电视机,音响,电冰箱,洗衣机等),物联网中的节点,娱乐终端(例如AR,VR等可穿戴设备),智能办公中智能设备(例如,打印机,投影仪,扩音器,音响等),车联网中的车联网设备,日常生活场景中的基础设施(例如自动售货机,商超的自助导航台,自助收银设备,自助点餐机等),以及大型体育以及音乐场馆的设备等。本申请实施例中对于STA和AP的具体形式不做特殊限制,在此仅是示例性说明。
为了便于理解本发明实施例,下面先介绍一下目前关于OMI机制的实现包括的技术方案,以下示例性的进行说明。
为了提高WiFi设备的灵活性,802.11ax标准引入OMI机制。在OMI机制中,STA为OMI发起方,AP为OMI响应方,STA可以向AP发送包含运行模式(operatingmode,OM)控制字段的数据帧或控制帧,实现STA动态切换单用户/多用户运行模式、信道带宽、最大接收空间流数等。例如,请参阅图2,图2是本申请实施例提供的一种OMI机制的实现场景图。如图2所示,STA可以通过向AP发送发送运行模式(transmitoperatingmode,TOM)切换上行链路的单用户/多用户运行模式,也可以通过向AP发送接收运行模式(receiveoperatingmode,ROM)切换下行链路的信道带宽和最大空间流数。在一种可能的实现方式中,请参阅图3(a),图3(a)是本申请实施例提供的一种OM控制字段的结构示意图。如图3(a)所示,OM控制字段可以包括接收端空间流数(receiver number of spatial streams,Rx NSS)、信道带宽(channelwidth)、上行多用户无效(uplink multi-user disabled,UL MU disabled)、发送端的空时流数目(transmitter the number of space-time streams,Tx NSTS)、ER单用户无效(single user disabled,ER SU disabled)、建议重新探测信道或增加信道探测(DL MU-MIMO resound recommendation)和上行多用户数据无效(uplink multi-user datadisabled,UL MU datadisabled)等。
目前的OMI机制存在以下问题:
1.支持STA发起OM协商导致运行模式切换的灵活性较差,业务传输的效率较低;
2.请参阅图3(b),图3(b)是本申请实施例提供的一种在TXOP内传输数据的场景示意图。如图3(b)所示,当AP发起下行数据传输时,STA无法通过感知AP侧待传输的数据量,在一个TXOP内发起OM协商并完成运行模式切换,导致STA运行模式切换的时效性差;
3.STA无法通知AP当前运行模式的切换状态或切换完成时间,从而导致AP可能提前下发数据而造成数据包频发重发、丢包等情况,导致吞吐量下降、传输时延增加;
4.STA的运行模式切换时延较大,难以满足时延要求高的业务需求。
基于上述问题,本申请实施例提供一种通信方法,第一设备可以生成并向第二设备发送用于指示是否包含运行模式参数的第一帧,实现第一设备主动发起运行模式协商,或者通过第一帧响应第二设备发起的运行模式协商,从而可以提高运行模式切换的灵活性,提高业务传输的效率。
本申请提供了多种运行模式切换的传输方法,下面将分别通过如下各实施例进行描述。这些运行模式切换的传输方法有些仅针对OMI机制中的部分流程,有些可以应用于OMI机制中的任意一个或多个流程。应理解的是,这些运行模式切换的传输方法可以相互结合使用,比如,可以是OMI机制中的某一流程使用一种方法而另一流程使用另一种方法,还可以是OMI机制中的某一流程既使用一种方法又使用另一种方法。
应理解的是,OMI机制有可能会随着技术方案的演进而发生变化,本申请提供的技术方案并不限于下面描述的过程。进一步地,本申请实施例中对场景的描述仅为举例,并不限定本申请实施例的方案仅能运 用为描述场景中,同样适用于存在类似问题的场景等。
本申请实施例(如下述图5-图9对应的实施例)中以第一设备和第二设备作为交互示意的执行主体为例来示意方法,但本申请并不限制交互示意的执行主体。例如,第一设备也可以是支持该第一设备实现该方法的芯片、芯片系统、或处理器,还可以是能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件;第二设备也可以是支持该第二设备实现该方法的芯片、芯片系统、或处理器,还可以是能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。其中,实施例中可以以第一设备是STA,第二设备是AP进行示例性说明。本申请实施例在这里做统一说明,后续不再赘述。
请参阅图4,图4是本申请实施例提供的一种通信方法的流程交互图。如图4所示,该通信方法包括但不限于以下步骤。
S401、第一设备和第二设备建立无线通信链路,第一设备工作在第一运行模式。
第一设备和第二设备建立无线通信链路,第一设备可以工作在第一运行模式,第二设备可以工作在第三运行模式。
不同运行模式可以对应不同带宽,其中,第一运行模式可以对应第一带宽,该第一带宽可以是第一信道带宽;第二运行模式可以对应第二带宽,该第二带宽可以是第二信道带宽;第三运行模式可以对应第三带宽,该第一带宽可以是第三信道带宽。第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
或者,不同运行模式可以对应不同功耗工作模式,例如,第一运行模式为低功耗监听模式,第二运行模式为高功耗接收模式。
S402、第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,与第二设备进行通信。
一种可能的实现方式,在满足第一条件的情况下,第一设备可以从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,第一条件包括以下一项或多项:
第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者,
第一设备与第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。第一阈值可以是预定义的。
第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的实现方式可以是下述图5、图14和图16所示的任一实现方式。下面进行具体介绍:
请参阅图5,图5是本申请实施例提供的另一种通信方法的流程交互图。如图5所示,该通信方法包括但不限于以下步骤,其中步骤S501、S502和S508是可选的步骤。
S501、第一设备向第二设备发送用于指示第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间的第七帧。相应地,第二设备接收来自第一设备的第七帧。
第一设备和第二设备在当前TXOP开始之前,可以规定好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间,实现方式可以是以下任一:
方式一、静态协商。具体地,第一设备和第二设备间可以通过协议规定或者预定义的方式约定好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。可选地,第一设备与第二设备可以不发送第一帧和第二帧。
方式二、半静态协商。具体地,第一设备在接入第二设备的过程中,可以在接入的交互关联帧中携带第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。
方式三、动态协商。具体地,第一设备可以向第二设备发送第七帧,告知第二设备第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。
S502、第二设备向第一设备发送用于响应第七帧的第八帧。相应地,第一设备接收来自第二设备的第八帧。
对于上述步骤S501中的第一设备和第二设备在当前TXOP开始之前,规定好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间的实现方式三来说,第二设备还可以向第一设备发送第八帧,用于响应第七帧,表示已知第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。
S503、第二设备生成包括第二字段的第二帧,第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数,可以理解为,第二设备向第一设备推荐运行模式参数,还可以理解为,第二设备向第一设备指示运行模式参数。即第一设备可以参考第二字段确定运行模式参数或者直接使用第二字段指示的运行模式参数。
第二帧可以理解为包括第二字段的RTS帧,或者为包括第二字段的触发(trigger)帧,或者为包括第二字段的管理帧,或者为包括第二字段的动作帧。一种可能的实现方式,第二帧可以为OMI RTS帧,可以理解,OMI RTS帧仅为示例性名称,还可以是其它的名称,本实施例对第二帧的名称不作限制。
请参阅图6,图6是本申请实施例提供的一种第二帧的结构示意图。如图6所示,第二帧可以为包括第二字段的RTS帧,其中,第二帧的帧控制(framecontrol)字段的B7-B2为101111,第二帧可以包括帧控制(frame control)字段、持续时间(duration)字段、收端地址(receiver address,RA)字段、发送端地址(transmitteraddress,TA)字段、第二字段和帧校验序列(frame check sequence,FCS)字段。
请参阅图7,图7是本申请实施例提供的一种第二字段的结构示意图。一种可能的实现方式,如图7的(a)所示,第二字段可以为OM控制(OM control)字段,OM控制字段可以包括Rx NSS和信道带宽(channelwidth)。具体的各字段名与对应的描述说明可以参考下表表1。
表1各字段名与对应的描述说明
另一种可能的实现方式,如图7的(b)所示,第二字段可以为扩展OM控制(extended OM control)字段。扩展OM控制字段在包括Rx NSS和信道带宽(channelwidth)的基础上,还可以包括运行模式推荐指示(ROM recommendationindication)和/或运行模式协商指示(negotiateindication),进一步还可以包括保留(reserved)子字段。具体的各字段名与对应的描述说明可以参考下表表2。
表2各字段名与对应的描述说明
进一步可选地,如图7的(c)所示,扩展OM控制字段还可以包括信号带宽(signalwidth)。具体的信号带宽的数值与对应的描述说明可以参考下表表3。
表3信号带宽的数值与对应的描述说明
可选地,第二设备可以预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据,可以根据第二帧中的第二字段包含的运行模式参数(例如信道带宽(channelwidth))选择对应的PHY层模块校准数据,配置PHY层寄存器。通过预先存储不同运行模式的PHY层模块校准数据并根据第二字段的运行模式参数配置PHY层寄存器,可以减小运行模式切换的时间,降低时延,例如第二设备可以从运行在20MHz的信道带宽切换到运行在160MHz,运行模式切换时间可由100ms~200ms缩减至约100us,实现微秒级信道切换。
其中,第二设备预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据,可能的实现方式,第二设备可以预存第一带宽运行模式的PHY层模块校准数据,第一带宽为大于或等于第一阈值的带宽,从而第二设备可以在信道 切换后采用小于第一带宽的信号带宽收发信号。
在第二字段包括信号带宽(signalwidth)的情况下,第二设备可以根据第二帧中第二字段包括的信道带宽(signalwidth),选择对应的PHY层模块校准数据,配置PHY层寄存器。例如第二设备运行在20MHz信道带宽上不变,可以切换20MHz信道带宽上的信号带宽,如从20MHz信道带宽上的20MHz信号带宽切换到20MHz信道带宽上的160MHz信号带宽。
S504、第二设备向第一设备发送第二帧。相应地,第一设备接收来自第二设备的第二帧。
一种可能的实现方式,在第二设备的待传输数据量大于或等于第二阈值,或者第二设备的待传输数据的所需传输时间大于或等于第三阈值的情况下,第二设备可以向第一设备发送第二帧。
第二设备可以根据自身业务的待传输数据量、时延需求、信道状态等信息主动向第一设备发起OM协商,提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性。另外,当第二设备发起下行数据传输时,无需第一设备感知第二设备侧的传输的数据量,第一设备只需要响应来自第二设备的第二帧,就可以实现运行模式切换,从而可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
第二设备可以通过向第一设备发送第二帧来主动发起OM协商,并将第二帧中的第二字段包括的运行模式协商指示(negotiateindication)字段设置为1,表示向第一设备推荐运行模式参数。
第二设备还可以根据业务的待传输数据量、时延需求、信道状态等信息,选择合理高效的第一设备的ROM配置方案,具体地,将第二帧中的第二字段包括的运行模式推荐指示(ROM recommendationindication)字段设置为1,表示利用Rx NSS和信道带宽字段携带ROM推荐信息。允许第二设备根据业务的待传输数据量、时延需求、信道状态等信息为第一设备推荐ROM配置方案,可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的有效性。
S505、第一设备生成包括第一字段的第一帧,第一字段包含运行模式参数。
第一帧可以理解为包括第一字段的CTS帧,或者为包括第一字段的触发(trigger)帧,或者为包括第一字段的管理帧,或者为包括第一字段的动作帧。一种可能的实现方式,第一帧可以为OMI CTS帧,可以理解,OMI CTS帧仅为示例性名称,还可以是其它的名称,本实施例对第一帧的名称不作限制。
请参阅图8,图8是本申请实施例提供的一种第一帧的结构示意图。如图8所示,第一帧可以为包括第一字段的CTS帧,其中,第一帧的帧控制(framecontrol)字段的B7-B2为110011,第一帧可以包括帧控制(frame control)字段、持续时间(duration)字段、收端地址(receiver address,RA)字段、第一字段和帧校验序列(frame check sequence,FCS)字段。
请参阅图9,图9是本申请实施例提供的一种第一字段的结构示意图。一种可能的实现方式,第一字段可以为上述图3(a)所示的OM控制(OM control)字段。另一种可能的实现方式,如图9的(a)所示,第二字段可以为扩展OM控制(extended OM control)字段。扩展OM控制字段在包括Rx NSS、信道带宽(channelwidth)、UL MU disabled、Tx NSTS、ER SU disabled、建议重新探测信道或增加信道探测(DL MU-MIMO resound recommendation)和UL MU datadisabled的基础上,还可以包括运行模式切换持续时间(durationindication)和保留(reserved)子字段。具体的各字段名与对应的描述说明可以参考下表表4。
表4各字段名与对应的描述说明
进一步可选地,如图9的(b)所示,扩展OM控制字段还可以包括切换持续时间(switchduration)。具体的各字段名与对应的描述说明可以参考下表表5。
表5各字段名与对应的描述说明
或者进一步可选地,如图9的(c)所示,扩展OM控制字段还可以包括信号带宽(signalwidth)。
第一设备可以预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据,在第一设备接收到来自第二设备的第二帧的情况下,第一设备可以向第二设备发送用于响应第二帧的第一帧,并根据第一帧中的第一字段包含的运行 模式参数(例如信道带宽(channelwidth))选择对应的PHY层模块校准数据,配置PHY层寄存器。通过预先存储不同运行模式的PHY层模块校准数据并根据第一字段的运行模式参数配置PHY层寄存器,可以减小运行模式切换的时间,降低时延,例如第一设备可以从运行在20MHz的信道带宽切换到运行在160MHz,运行模式切换时间可由100ms~200ms缩减至约100us,实现微秒级信道切换。
其中,第一设备预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据,一种可能的实现方式,第一设备可以预存第一带宽运行模式的PHY层模块校准数据,第一带宽为大于或等于第一阈值的带宽,从而第一设备可以在信道切换后采用小于第一带宽的信号带宽收发信号,从而可以简化实现的复杂度。
在第一字段包括信号带宽(signalwidth)的情况下,第一设备可以根据第一帧中第一字段包括的信道带宽(signalwidth),选择对应的PHY层模块校准数据,配置PHY层寄存器。例如第一设备运行在20MHz信道带宽上不变,可以切换20MHz信道带宽上的信号带宽,如从20MHz信道带宽上的20MHz信号带宽切换到20MHz信道带宽上的160MHz信号带宽。
S506、第一设备向第二设备发送第一帧。相应地,第二设备接收来自第一设备的第一帧。
第一设备接收来自第二设备的第二帧后,可以响应于所述第二帧,向第二设备发送第一帧。
S507、在第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间(switchduration),第一设备与第二设备之间进行数据传输。
示例性地,第二设备可以向第一设备发送数据(如协议数据单元(presentationprotocoldataunit,PPDU)),第一设备向第二设备发送ACK帧表示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据。或者,第一设备可以向第二设备发送数据,第二设备向第一设备发送ACK帧。
在第一设备的模式切换期间,第一设备和第二设备进行收发数据,可以提高空口利用率,并且可以避免由于切换时间较长而导致的其它用户抢占信道的问题。
S508、第一设备向第二设备发送用于指示运行模式切换完成的第三帧。相应地,第二设备接收来自第一设备的第三帧。
第三帧可以理解为用于指示运行模式切换完成的ACK帧。即第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式完成后,第一设备可以向第二设备发送第三帧。一种可能的实现方式,第三帧可以为OMI ACK帧,可以理解,OMI ACK帧仅为示例性名称,还可以是其它的名称,本实施例对第三帧的名称不作限制。
请参阅图10,图10是本申请实施例提供的一种第三帧的结构示意图。如图10所示,第三帧的帧结构(framecontrol)字段的B7-B2为110111,第三帧可以包括帧控制(frame control)字段、持续时间(duration)字段、收端地址(receiver address,RA)字段、第三字段和帧校验序列(frame check sequence,FCS)字段。
请参阅图11,图11是本申请实施例提供的一种第三字段的结构示意图。一种可能的实现方式,如图11所示,第三字段可以为OM公告(OM announcement)字段,OM公告字段可以包括Rx NSS、信道带宽(channelwidth)、UL MU disabled、Tx NSTS、ER SU disabled、建议重新探测信道或增加信道探测(DL MU-MIMO resound recommendation)、UL MU datadisabled、完成指示(completeindication)和保留(reserved)子字段。具体的第三字段中的各字段名与对应的描述说明可以参考下表表6。
表6各字段名与对应的描述说明
第一设备向第二设备发送第三帧的实现方式可以为以下任一:
方式一、在第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第一数值的情况下,第一设备在完成运行模式切换后向第二设备发送第三帧。其中,第一数值可以是0。例如,当第一帧中的第一字段包括的运行模式切换持续时间指示子字段设置为0时,表示第一字段中不携带第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间,第一设备可以在完成运行模式切换后向第二设备发送第三帧,以通知第二设备下发数据。
方式二、在第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间大于第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间的情况下,第一设备在完成运行模式切换后向第二设备发送第三帧。对于不支持快速信道切换的第一设备,第一设备运行模式切换时间较长,无法采用第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间完成运行模式切换,第一设备可以在完成运行模式切换后向第二设备发送第三帧,指示已完成运行模式切换,以通知第 二设备下发数据。
进一步地,为了减小第一设备侧的上行信号对邻近用户的同道干扰,第一设备可以选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向第二设备发送第三帧。示例性地,请参阅图12,图12是第一设备发送第三帧的场景示意图。如图12所示,第一设备STA1切换后的信道带宽BW=160MHz与STA2的信道带宽相同,第一设备STA1可以选择切换后的信道带宽BW=160MHz和原信号带宽SW=20MHz向第二设备AP1发送第三帧,以减小对STA2的数据传输的影响。
第一设备通过第三帧指示已完成运行模式切换,可以实现高效、可靠的业务传输,可以解决第一设备无法通知第二设备当前运行模式的切换状态或切换完成时间,从而导致AP可能提前下发数据而造成数据包频发重发、丢包等情况,导致吞吐量下降、传输时延增加的问题。
一种可能的实现方式,如果第一设备和第二设备在当前TXOP之间已经协商好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间(见上述步骤S501和S502),则第一设备可以不再向第二设备发送第三帧。
S509、第一设备与第二设备之间进行数据传输。
示例性地,第二设备可以向第一设备下发数据。第二设备向第一设备下发数据的实现方式可以为以下任一:
方式一、第二设备接收到来自第一设备的第三帧后,向第一设备下发数据。具体地:一种可能的实现方式,第二设备可以在接收到第三帧后,按照切换后的运行模式立即向第一设备下发数据;一种可能的实现方式,第二设备在接收到第三帧后,按照切换后的运行模式经过一定的帧间间隔(SIFS)向第一设备下发数据;一种可能的实现方式,第二设备在接收到第三帧后,第一设备向第二设备发送用于请求下发数据的请求消息,第二设备收到该请求消息后,按照切换后的运行模式向第一设备下发数据;一种可能的实现方式,第二设备在接收到第三帧后,第一设备向第二设备发送用于请求下发数据的请求帧(requestframe),第二设备收到该请求帧后向第一设备回复响应于请求帧的响应帧(responseframe)后,按照切换后的运行模式向第一设备下发数据;一种可能的实现方式,第二设备在预设时间内未收到第三帧和/或用于请求下发数据的请求帧,按照切换前的运行模式向第一设备下发数据。
方式二、在第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第二数值的情况下,所述第二设备在所述运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间后向所述第一设备下发数据。例如,当第一帧中的第一字段包括的运行模式切换持续时间指示子字段设置为1时,第一字段包括的切换持续时间子字段指示第一设备的运行模式切换时间,第二设备可以在该时间后向第一设备下发数据。
方式三、在TXOP之前协商好的第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间后,向第二设备下发数据。
第二设备可以根据接收到第三帧或者第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示或者根据协商好的第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间,确定向第一设备下发数据的时间,可以实现高效的业务传输。
S510、第二设备向第一设备发送第四帧,第四帧用于指示当前TXOP结束。相应地,第一设备接收来自第二设备的第四帧。
一种可能的实现方式,第四帧可以为CF-end帧。
第二设备向第一设备下发数据完后,可以发送第四帧提前结束当前TXOP,从而可以实现高效的业务传输。
下面结合上述步骤S501-步骤S510,对本实施例进行举例说明。请参阅图13,图13是本申请实施例提供的一种通信方法示例性说明的示意图。其中,可以以第一帧为OMI CTS帧,第二帧为OMI RTS帧,第三帧为OMI ACK帧,第四帧为CF-end帧,第二设备向第一设备下发数据为例进行示例性说明:
首先先介绍下述各示例性实施例中所用到的运行模式类型:
如上表所示,运行模式类型可以包括OM1、OM2、OM3和OM4。其中,OM1所对应的信道带宽和信号 带宽分别为BW1和SW1,OM2所对应的信道带宽和信号带宽分别为BW2和SW2,OM3所对应的信道带宽和信号带宽分别为BW1和SW2,OM4所对应的信道带宽和信号带宽分别为BW1和SW1或SW2。
如图13的(a)和图13的(b)所示,第二设备主动发起OM协商。具体地,在当前TXOP内,第二设备可以基于目标运行模式OM1向第一设备发送OMI RTS帧用于发起OM协商,OMI RTS可以向第一设备指示目标运行模式类型为OM1,即请求第一设备从第一运行模式OM2切换到第二运行模式OM1。该OMI RTS帧包括第二字段,第二字段为OM control字段或者extended OM control字段,第一设备可以响应于OMI RTS帧,基于OM2向第二设备发送OMI CTS帧用于响应OMI RTS帧,该OMI CTS帧包括第一字段,第一字段为OM control字段或者extended OM control字段,extended OM control字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示(durationindication)子字段。
如图13的(a)所示,在第一字段包括extendedOM control字段的情况下,当OMI CTS帧中的运行模式切换持续时间指示(durationindication)子字段设置为0时,第一设备在运行模式切换完成之后,可以基于OM4(即基于切换前的运行模式类型或者切换后的运行模式类型)向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧表示运行模式已切换完成,以通知第二设备下发数据。
或者在第一字段包括OM control字段的情况下,第一设备在运行模式切换完成之后,可以基于OM4向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧表示运行模式已切换完成,以通知第二设备下发数据。在第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间,第二设备可以基于OM3向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM2向第二设备发送ACK帧表示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据。在第一设备的模式切换期间,第一设备和第二设备进行收发数据,可以提高空口利用率,并且可以避免由于切换时间较长而导致的其它用户抢占信道的问题。第二设备在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后可以基于OM1向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM4向第二设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据。第二设备还可以基于OM1向第一设备发送CF-end帧,提前结束当前TXOP。从图13的(a)可以看出,第一设备在运行模式切换后的TXOP2相比于在运行模式切换前的TXOP1短,从而可以提高数据传输的效率。
如图13的(b)所示,在第一字段包括extendedOM control字段的情况下,当OMI CTS帧中的运行模式切换持续时间指示(durationindication)子字段设置为1时,第一设备可以在第一字段包括的切换持续时间(switch duration)指示的时间(即切换持续时间(switchduration))完成运行模式切换,可以不需要向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧。第二设备可以根据切换持续时间(switch duration)指示的时间确认第一设备已完成运行模式切换,可以基于OM1向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM4向第二设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据。在第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间,第二设备可以基于OM3向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM2向第二设备发送ACK帧表示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据。在第一设备的模式切换期间,第一设备和第二设备进行收发数据,可以提高空口利用率,并且可以避免由于切换时间较长而导致的其它用户抢占信道的问题。第二设备还可以基于OM1向第一设备发送CF-end帧,提前结束当前TXOP。从图13的(b)可以看出,第一设备在运行模式切换后的TXOP3相比于在运行模式切换前的TXOP1短,从而可以提高数据传输的效率。
图13的(c)、图13的(d)、图13的(e)、图13的(f)与上述图13的(a)和图13的(b)的区别点在于:图13的(a)和图13的(b)中,可以在当前TXOP内协商第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间,图13的(c)、图13的(d)、图13的(e)、图13的(f)中,可以在当前TXOP外协商第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。具体如下:
一种可能的实现方式,如图13的(c)所示,第一设备和第二设备在当前TXOP开始之前,可以静态协商好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间,例如可以通过协议规定或者预定义的方式约定好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间,例如切换时间T。在当前TXOP内,可选地第二设备可以基于OM1向第一设备发送RTS帧,第一设备基于OM2向第二设备发送CTS帧。第一设备可以根据切换时间T开始从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式。在模式切换完成后,可选地第一设备可以基于OM4向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧表示运行模式已切换完成,以通知第二设备下发数据;第二设备在接收到OMI ACK帧后或者在切换时间T后,在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)开始基于OM1向第一设备下发数据。第一设备基于OM4向第二设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据。在第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间,第二设备可以基于OM3向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM2向第二设备发送ACK帧表示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据。在第一设备的模式切换期间,第一设备和第二设备进行收发数据,可以提高空口利用率,并且可以避免由于切换时间较长而导致的其它用户抢占信道的问题。第二设备还可以基于OM1向第一设备发送CF-end帧,提前结束当前TXOP。从图13的(c)可以看出,第一设备在运行模式切换 后的TXOP2相比于在运行模式切换前的TXOP1短,从而可以提高数据传输的效率。
一种可能的实现方式,图13未示出,第一设备和第二设备在当前TXOP开始之前,可以半静态协商好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间,例如第一设备在接入第二设备的过程中,可以在接入的交互关联帧(如下述的第七帧和第八帧)中携带第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间,例如切换时间T。在当前TXOP内的实现方式与上述图13的(c)相同,具体描述可以参考图13的(c),不再赘述。
一种可能的实现方式,如图13的(d)所示,第一设备和第二设备可以在当前TXOP开始之前,可以动态协商好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间,例如第二设备基于OM2或OM3向第一设备发送第二帧,用于发起OM协商,第二可以向第一设备指示目标运行模式类型为OM1,即请求第一设备从第一运行模式OM2切换到第二运行模式OM1。该第二帧包括第二字段,第二字段为OM control字段或者extended OM control字段,第一设备可以响应于第二帧,基于OM2向第二设备发送第一帧,该第一帧包括第一字段,第一字段为extended OM control字段,extended OM control字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示(durationindication)子字段。运行模式切换持续时间指示(durationindication)子字段用于指示切换时间T。在当前TXOP内的实现方式与上述图13的(c)相同,具体描述可以参考图13的(c),不再赘述。
图13的(e)、图13的(f)与图13的(c)、图13的(d)的区别点在于:图13的(c)、图13的(d)中,第一设备可以在当前TXOP内实现从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式。图13的(e)、图13的(f)中,第一设备可以在当前TXOP外实现从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式。具体如下:
第一种可能的实现方式,如图13的(e)所示,第一设备和第二设备在当前TXOP开始之前,可以半静态协商好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。具体地,第一设备可以基于OM2向第二设备发送第七帧,第七帧用于指示切换时间T,第二设备基于OM2或OM3向第一设备发送第八帧,用于响应第七帧。第二设备可以基于OM2或OM3向第一设备发送第二帧,用于发起OM协商,第二帧可以向第一设备指示目标运行模式类型为OM1,即请求第一设备从第一运行模式OM2切换到第二运行模式OM1。该第二帧包括第二字段,第二字段为OM control字段或者extended OM control字段,第一设备可以响应于第二帧,基于OM2向第二设备发送第一帧,该第一帧包括第一字段,第一字段为OM control字段。第一设备向第二设备发送第一帧后,在切换时间T内完成从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式。在模式切换完成后,可选地第一设备可以基于OM4向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧表示运行模式已切换完成,以通知第二设备下发数据。在TXOP之前第一设备完成运行模式切换,在当前TXOP内,可选地,第二设备可以基于OM1发送RTS帧,第一设备可以基于OM4发送CTS帧进行数据交互。在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后,第二设备开始周期性地基于OM1向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM4向第二设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据,直到当前TXOP结束。从该实现方式可以看出,第一设备在当前TXOP之前完成运行模式切换,在当前TXOP内使用切换后的运行模式进行数据传输,从而可以提高数据传输的效率。
第二种可能的实现方式,图13未示出,第一设备和第二设备在当前TXOP开始之前,可以静态协商好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间,具体描述可以参考上述。第一设备在当前TXOP之前完成运行模式切换,在当前TXOP内使用切换后的运行模式进行数据传输,具体描述与第一种可能的实现方式相同,可以参考第一种可能的实现方式,不再赘述。
图13的(f)与图13的(e)的区别点在于:图13的(e)是下行数据传输的示意图,图13的(f)是上行数据传输的示意图。
第三种可能的实现方式,如图13的(f)所示,第一设备和第二设备在当前TXOP开始之前,可以半静态协商好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。第一设备在当前TXOP之前完成运行模式切换,具体描述与第一种可能的实现方式相同,可以参考第一种可能的实现方式,不再赘述。在当前TXOP内,可选地第一设备可以基于OM4发送RTS帧,在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后,第二设备可以基于OM1发送CTS帧,进行数据交互。在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后,第一设备开始周期性地基于OM1向第一设备发送数据,第二设备基于OM1向第一设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据,直到当前TXOP结束。从图13的(f)可以看出,第一设备在当前TXOP之前完成运行模式切换,在当前TXOP内使用切换后的运行模式进行数据传输,从而可以提高数据传输的效率。
应理解,在本实施例中,上述各过程的序号的大小并不意味着执行顺序的先后,各过程的执行顺序应以其功能和内在逻辑确定,而不应对本申请实施例的实施过程构成任何限定。
本实施例中,第二设备可以主动向第一设备发起OM协商,例如第二设备可以根据自身业务的待传输数据量、时延需求、信道状态等信息主动向第一设备发起OM协商,从而提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性。 另外,当第二设备发起下行数据传输时,无需第一设备感知第二设备侧的传输的数据量,第一设备只需要响应来自第二设备的第二帧,就可以实现运行模式切换,从而可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
下面对本申请实施例提供的另一种通信方法进行描述。应理解,本申请中不同实施例的术语解释可以互相参考,为避免描述冗余,不同实施例可以不对同一术语赘述。请参阅图14,图14是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信方法的流程交互图。如图14所示,该通信方法包括但不限于以下步骤,其中步骤S1401、S1402和S1407是可选的步骤。
S1401、第一设备向第二设备发送用于指示第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间的第七帧。相应地,第二设备接收来自第一设备的第七帧。
S1402、第二设备向第一设备发送用于响应第七帧的第八帧。相应地,第一设备接收来自第二设备的第八帧。
可以理解,步骤S1401-S1402的具体实现方式可参考上述步骤S501-S502,在此不作赘述。
S1403、第二设备向第一设备发第五帧,第五帧用于请求第二设备向第一设备传输数据。相应地,第一设备接收来自第二设备的第五帧。
第五帧可以理解为不包括第二字段的RTS帧,即常规(regular)RTS帧,用于请求第二设备向第一设备传输数据。
S1404、第一设备生成包括第一字段的第一帧,第一字段包含运行模式参数。
第一设备接收来自第二设备的第五帧后,可以生成第一帧。具体的实现方式可以参考上述步骤S505,在此不作赘述。
S1405、第一设备向第二设备发送第一帧。相应地,第二设备接收来自第一设备的第一帧。
第一设备可以向第二设备发送第一帧,以主动发起OM协商。
第一设备向第二设备发送第一帧的实现方式可以为以下任一:
方式一、第一设备可以根据第五帧评估第二设备侧待传输的数据量,从而自主决策是否发起OM协商,即自主决策是否向第二设备发送第一帧。例如在TXOP大于或等于第四阈值的情况下,第一设备可以在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
方式二、在第五帧中的TXOP时长(duration)指示的时间超过预设门限(threshold,即TH)时,第一设备可以在当前TXOP内向第二设备发送第一帧,主动发起OM协商。
第一设备可以在一个TXOP内主动向第二设备发起OM协商,实现运行模式切换,从而可以提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
S1406、在第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间(switchduration),第一设备与第二设备之间进行数据传输。
S1407、第一设备向第二设备发送用于指示运行模式切换完成的第三帧。相应地,第二设备接收来自第一设备的第三帧。
可以理解,步骤S1406-S1407的具体实现方式可以参考上述步骤S507-S508,在此不作赘述。
S1408、第一设备与第二设备之间进行数据传输。
S1409、第二设备向第一设备发送第四帧,第四帧用于指示当前TXOP结束。相应地,第一设备接收来自第二设备的第四帧。
可以理解,步骤S1408-S1409的具体实现方式可参考上述步骤S509-S510,在此不作赘述。
下面结合上述步骤S1401-步骤S1409,对本实施例进行举例说明。请参阅图15,图15是本申请实施例提供的另一种通信方法示例性说明的示意图。其中,可以以第一帧为OMI CTS帧,第三帧为OMI ACK帧,第四帧为CF-end帧,第五帧为RTS帧,第二设备向第一设备下发数据为例进行示例性说明:
如图15的(a)和图15的(b)所示,在当前TXOP内,第二设备可以基于目标运行模式OM1向第一设备发送RTS帧用于请求第一设备向第二设备传输数据,第一设备可以根据第五帧,基于OM2向第二设备发送OMI CTS帧用于发起OM协商。该OMI CTS帧包括第一字段,第一字段为OM control字段或者extended OM control字段,extended OM control字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示(durationindication)子字段。
如图15的(a)所示,在第一字段包括extendedOM control字段的情况下,当OMI CTS帧中的运行模式切换持续时间指示(durationindication)子字段设置为0时,第一设备在运行模式切换完成之后,可以基于 OM4向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧表示运行模式已切换完成,以通知第二设备下发数据。
或者在第一字段包括OM control字段的情况下,第一设备在运行模式切换完成之后,可以基于OM4向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧表示运行模式已切换完成,以通知第二设备下发数据。在第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间,第二设备可以基于OM3向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM2向第二设备发送ACK帧表示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据。在第一设备的模式切换期间,第一设备和第二设备进行收发数据,可以提高空口利用率,并且可以避免由于切换时间较长而导致的其它用户抢占信道的问题。第二设备在一定时间间隙(SIFS)后可以基于OM1向第一设备下发数据。第一设备基于OM4向第二设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据。第二设备还可以基于OM1向第一设备发送CF-end帧,提前结束当前TXOP。从图15的(a)可以看出,第一设备在运行模式切换后的TXOP2相比于在运行模式切换前的TXOP1短,从而可以提高数据传输的效率。
如图15的(b)所示,在第一字段包括extendedOM control字段的情况下,当OMI CTS帧中的运行模式切换持续时间指示(durationindication)子字段设置为1时,第一设备可以在第一字段包括的切换持续时间(switch duration)指示的时间(即切换持续时间(switchduration))完成运行模式切换,可以不需要向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧。第二设备可以根据切换持续时间(switch duration)指示的时间确认第一设备已完成运行模式切换,可以基于OM1向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM4向第二设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据。在第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间,第二设备可以基于OM3向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM2向第二设备发送ACK帧表示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据。在第一设备的模式切换期间,第一设备和第二设备进行收发数据,可以提高空口利用率,并且可以避免由于切换时间较长而导致的其它用户抢占信道的问题。第二设备还可以基于OM1向第一设备发送CF-end帧,提前结束当前TXOP。从图15的(b)可以看出,第一设备在运行模式切换后的TXOP3相比于在运行模式切换前的TXOP1短,从而可以提高数据传输的效率。
另外,与上述图13的(c)~图13的(f)类似,第一设备与第二设备可以在当前TXOP外协商第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。具体的实现方式可以参考上述图13的描述,不再赘述。
其中以图13的(f)为例,对应图15的(c)来看,其中,图13的(f)中是由第二设备主动发起OM协商,图15的(c)中是由第一设备主动发起OM协商。具体地,第一设备和第二设备在当前TXOP开始之前,可以半静态协商好第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。第一设备可以基于OM2向第二设备发送第七帧,第七帧用于指示切换时间T,第二设备基于OM2或OM3向第一设备发送第八帧,用于响应第七帧。第一设备可以基于OM2向第二设备发送第一帧用于发起OM协商,第二设备响应于第一帧,基于OM2或OM3向第一设备发送第十一帧,第十一帧可以是一个管理帧或动作帧等。其中,该第一帧包括第一字段,第一字段为OM control字段或者extended OM control字段,extended OM control字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示(durationindication)子字段。第一设备向第二设备发送第一帧后,在切换时间T内完成从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式。在模式切换完成后,可选地第一设备可以基于OM1向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧表示运行模式已切换完成。在TXOP之前第一设备完成运行模式切换,在当前TXOP内,可选地,第一设备可以基于OM1发送RTS帧,第二设备可以基于OM1发送CTS帧进行数据交互。在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后,第一设备开始周期性地基于OM1向第二设备发送数据,第一设备基于OM1向第二设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据,直到当前TXOP结束。从该实现方式可以看出,第一设备在当前TXOP之前完成运行模式切换,在当前TXOP内使用切换后的运行模式进行数据传输,从而可以提高数据传输的效率。
应理解,在本实施例中,上述各过程的序号的大小并不意味着执行顺序的先后,各过程的执行顺序应以其功能和内在逻辑确定,而不应对本申请实施例的实施过程构成任何限定。
本实施例中,第一设备可以主动向第二设备发起OM协商,例如第一设备可以根据接收到的第五帧主动向第一设备发起OM协商,从而提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性,提高第一设备的运行模式切换的时效性,减小运行模式切换的时延。
下面对本申请实施例提供的又一种通信方法进行描述。应理解,本申请中不同实施例的术语解释可以互相参考,为避免描述冗余,不同实施例可以不对同一术语赘述。请参阅图16,图16是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信方法的流程交互图。如图16所示,该通信方法包括但不限于以下步骤,其中步骤S1601、S1602和S1607是可选的步骤。
S1601、第一设备向第二设备发送用于指示第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间的第七帧。相应地,第二设备接收来自第一设备的第七帧。
S1602、第二设备向第一设备发送用于响应第七帧的第八帧。相应地,第一设备接收来自第二设备的第八帧。
可以理解,步骤S1601-S1602的具体实现方式可参考上述步骤S501-S502,在此不作赘述。
S1603、第二设备生成包括第二字段的第二帧,第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,第二字段用于推荐运行模式协商的参数。
S1604、第二设备向第一设备发送第二帧。相应地,第一设备接收来自第二设备的第二帧。
可以理解,步骤S1603-S1604的具体实现方式可参考上述步骤S503-S504,在此不作赘述。
S1605、第一设备向第二设备发送第六帧,第六帧用于响应第二帧。相应地,第二设备接收来自第一设备的第六帧。
第六帧可以理解为是不包括第一字段的CTS帧,即常规(regular)CTS帧,用于请响应第二帧。
S1606、在第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间(switchduration),第一设备与第二设备之间进行数据传输。
可以理解,步骤S1606的具体实现方式可参考上述步骤S507,在此不作赘述。
S1607、第一设备向第二设备发送用于指示运行模式切换完成的第三帧。相应地,第二设备接收来自第一设备的第三帧。
可以理解,第三帧的具体实现方式可参考上述步骤S508,在此不作赘述。
一种可能的实现方式,第一设备按照第二帧指示的运行模式参数切换运行模式后,可以向第二设备发送第三帧。
进一步地,为了减小第一设备侧的上行信号对邻近用户的同道干扰,第一设备可以选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向第二设备发送第三帧。
S1608、第一设备与第二设备之间进行数据传输。
示例性地,第二设备可以向第一设备下发数据。第二设备向第一设备下发数据的实现方式可以为以下任一:
方式一、第二设备接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第三帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
具体地:一种可能的实现方式,第二设备可以在接收到第三帧后,按照切换后的运行模式立即向第一设备下发数据;一种可能的实现方式,第二设备在接收到第三帧后,按照切换后的运行模式经过一定的帧间间隔(SIFS)向第一设备下发数据;一种可能的实现方式,第二设备在接收到第三帧后,第一设备向第二设备发送用于请求下发数据的请求消息,第二设备收到该请求消息后,按照切换后的运行模式向第一设备下发数据;一种可能的实现方式,第二设备在接收到第三帧后,第一设备向第二设备发送用于请求下发数据的请求帧(requestframe),第二设备收到该请求帧后向第一设备回复响应于请求帧的响应帧(responseframe)后,按照切换后的运行模式向第一设备下发数据;一种可能的实现方式,第二设备在预设时间内未收到第三帧和/或用于请求下发数据的请求帧,按照切换前的运行模式向第一设备下发数据。
方式二、第二设备接收到来自第一设备的第六帧后,向第一设备下发数据。具体地:一种可能的实现方式,第二设备接收到第六帧后,按照切换后的运行模式立即向第一设备下发数据;一种可能的实现方式,第二设备接收到第六帧后,按照切换后的运行模式经过一定的帧间间隔(SIFS)向第一设备下发数据;一种可能的实现方式,第二设备接收到第六帧后,按照切换后的运行模式经过一定的预设时间(例如第一设备和第二设备间约定的第一设备切换运行模式的时间)后向第一设备下发数据。
S1609、第二设备向第一设备发送第四帧,第四帧用于指示当前TXOP结束。相应地,第一设备接收来自第二设备的第四帧。
可以理解,步骤S1609的具体实现方式可参考上述步骤S510,在此不作赘述。
下面结合上述步骤S1601-步骤S1609,对本实施例进行举例说明。请参阅图17,图17是本申请实施例提供的一种通信方法示例性说明的示意图。其中,可以以第二帧为OMI RTS帧,第三帧为OMI ACK帧,第四帧为CF-end帧,第六帧为CTS帧,第二设备向第一设备下发数据为例进行示例性说明:
如图17所示,在当前TXOP内,第二设备可以基于目标运行模式OM1向第一设备发送OMI RTS帧用于发起OM协商,OMI RTS可以向第一设备指示目标运行模式类型为OM1,即请求第一设备从第一运行模式OM2切换到第二运行模式OM1。该OMI RTS帧包括第二字段,第二字段为OM control字段或者extended OM control字段,第一设备接收到OMI RTS帧,基于OM2向第二设备发送CTS帧,该CTS帧用于请求第二设备向第一设备传输数据。
第一设备向第二设备发送CTS帧后,在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后,开始从第一运行模式切换第二运行模式,第一设备在运行模式切换完成之后,可以基于OM4(即基于切换前的运行模式类型或者切换后的运行模式类型)向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧表示运行模式已切换完成,以通知第二设备下发数据。第二设备在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后可以基于OM1向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM4向第二设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据。在第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间,第二设备可以基于OM3向第一设备下发数据,第一设备基于OM2向第二设备发送ACK帧表示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据。在第一设备的模式切换期间,第一设备和第二设备进行收发数据,可以提高空口利用率,并且可以避免由于切换时间较长而导致的其它用户抢占信道的问题。第二设备还可以基于OM1向第一设备发送CF-end帧,提前结束当前TXOP。从图17可以看出,第一设备运行模式切换后的TXOP2相比于在运行模式切换前的TXOP1短,从而可提高数据传输的效率。
另外,与上述图13的(c)~图13的(f)类似,第一设备与第二设备可以在当前TXOP外协商第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。具体的实现方式可以参考上述图13的描述,不再赘述。
应理解,在本实施例中,上述各过程的序号的大小并不意味着执行顺序的先后,各过程的执行顺序应以其功能和内在逻辑确定,而不应对本申请实施例的实施过程构成任何限定。
本实施例中,第二设备可以主动向第一设备发起OM协商,例如第二设备可以根据自身业务的待传输数据量、时延需求、信道状态等信息主动向第一设备发起OM协商,第一设备可以响应于OM协商,向第二设备发送第六帧,从而提高运行模式切换协商的灵活性。
上述图5-图17描述的是单用户场景。一种可能的实现方式,请参阅图18,图18是本申请实施例提供的在一种多用户场景下的通信方法示例性说明的示意图。如图18所示,在多用户场景下,可以包括一个第二设备和多个第一设备(图18仅示出3个第一设备进行示例性说明,即多个第一设备包括第一设备1、第一设备2和第一设备3。其中,第一设备3可以是原设备(legacy),不支持在当前TXOP内切换运行模式)。其中,可以以第一帧为OMI CTS帧,第二帧为OMI MU RTS帧,第三帧为OMI ACK帧,第四帧为CF-end帧为例进行示例性说明:
首先先介绍所用到的运行模式类型:
如上表所示,运行模式类型可以包括OM1、OM2、OM3、OM4、OM12(OFDMA)、OM22(OFDMA)和OM32(OFDMA)。其中,OM1所对应的信道带宽和信号带宽分别为BW11和SW11,OM21所对应的信道带宽和信号带宽分别为BW21和SW21,OM3所对应的信道带宽和信号带宽分别为BW31和SW31,OM4所对应的信道带宽和信号带宽分别为BW41和SW41,OM12(OFDMA)所对应的信道带宽和信号带宽分别为BW11和SW12,OM22(OFDMA)所对应的信道带宽和信号带宽分别为BW11和SW22,OM32(OFDMA)所对应的信道带宽和信号带宽分别为BW11和SW32。
如图18的(a)所示,第二设备可以主动发起运行模式协商。具体地,在当前TXOP,第二设备可以基于OM11向多个第一设备发送第九帧,例如第九帧为多用户(mutilateuser,MU)RTS帧,多个第一设备可以分别基于OM21、OM31和OM41向第二设备发送第十帧,例如第十帧为CTS帧。在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后,第二设备可以基于OM11向第一设备1和第一设备2发送OMI MU RTS帧用于发起OM协商,OMI MU RTS帧可以向第一设备1和第一设备2指示目标运行模式类型为OM22和OM32,即请求第一设备1从第一运行模式OM21切换到第二运行模式OM22,请求第一设备2从第一运行模式OM31切换到第二运行模式OM32。该OMI MU RTS帧包括第二字段,第二字段为OM control字段或者extended OM control字段。第一设备1和第一设备2接收来自第二设备的OMI MU RTS帧后,可以向第二设备回复OMI CTS帧。在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后,第一设备1和第一设备2开始进行运行模式切换。在多个第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间,第二设备可以基于OM11向多个第一设备下发数据,第一设备1基于OM21向第二设备发送ACK帧表 示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据,第一设备2基于OM331向第二设备发送ACK帧表示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据。在第一设备的模式切换期间,第一设备和第二设备进行收发数据,可以提高空口利用率,并且可以避免由于切换时间较长而导致的其它用户抢占信道的问题。第一设备1和第一设备2在运行模式切换完成之后,可以分别基于OM21和OM31向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧表示运行模式已切换完成,以通知第二设备下发数据。第二设备在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后可以基于OM12向多个第一设备下发数据,第一设备1基于OM22向第二设备发送ACK帧,第一设备2基于OM32向第二设备发送ACK帧,第一设备3基于OM41向第二设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据。第二设备还可以基于OM12向多个第一设备发送CF-end帧,提前结束当前TXOP。从图18的(a)可以看出,多个第一设备在运行模式切换后的TXOP2相比于在运行模式切换前的TXOP1短,从而可以提高数据传输的效率。
如图18的(b)所示,第一设备可以主动发起运行模式协商。具体地,在当前TXOP,第二设备可以基于OM11向多个第一设备发送MU RTS帧,多个第一设备可以分别基于OM21、OM31和OM41向第二设备发送CTS帧。在一定帧间间隔(SIFS)后,第一设备1和第一设备2可以分别基于OM21和OM31向第二设备发送OMI CTS帧用于发起OM协商,并开始从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式。该OMI CTS帧包括第一字段,第一字段为OM control字段或者extended OM control字段,extended OM control字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示(durationindication)子字段。在多个第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式期间,第二设备可以基于OM11向多个第一设备下发数据,第一设备1基于OM21向第二设备发送ACK帧表示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据,第一设备2基于OM331向第二设备发送ACK帧表示收到数据或者指示是否重发数据。在第一设备的模式切换期间,第一设备和第二设备进行收发数据,可以提高空口利用率,并且可以避免由于切换时间较长而导致的其它用户抢占信道的问题。
在第一字段包括OM control字段的情况下,第一设备1和第一设备2在运行模式切换完成之后,可以分别基于OM21和OM31向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧表示运行模式已切换完成,以通知第二设备下发数据。第二设备在接收到OMI ACK帧后的一定帧间间隔(SIFS),可以基于OM12向多个第一设备下发数据。
在第一字段包括extendedOM control字段的情况下,第一设备1和第二设备2在运行模式切换完成之后,可以不用向第二设备发送OMI ACK帧。第二设备可以根据extendedOM control字段中的运行模式切换指示(durationindication)的时间向多个第一设备下发数据。
第二设备向多个第一设备下发数据,第一设备1基于OM22向第二设备发送ACK帧,第一设备2基于OM32向第二设备发送ACK帧,第一设备3基于OM41向第二设备发送ACK帧,用于表示收到数据。第二设备还可以基于OM12向多个第一设备发送CF-end帧,提前结束当前TXOP。从图18的(a)可以看出,多个第一设备在运行模式切换后的TXOP2相比于在运行模式切换前的TXOP1短,从而可以提高数据传输的效率。
另外,与上述图13的(c)~图13的(f)类似,第一设备与第二设备可以在当前TXOP外协商第一设备从第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式的切换时间。具体的实现方式可以参考上述图13的描述,不再赘述。
可以理解的,多个第一设备在于第二设备进行数据交互时,可以使用正交频分多址(orthogonal frequency division multiple access,OFDMA)与第二设备进行数据交互。
上述内容阐述了本申请提供的方法,为了便于更好地实施本申请实施例的上述方案,本申请实施例还提供了相应的装置。
本申请实施例可以根据上述方法示例对通信装置进行功能模块的划分,例如,可以对应各个功能划分各个功能模块,也可以将两个或两个以上的功能集成在一个处理模块中。上述集成的模块既可以采用硬件的形式实现,也可以采用软件功能模块的形式实现。需要说明的是,本申请实施例中对模块的划分是示意性的,仅仅为一种逻辑功能划分,实际实现时可以有另外的划分方式。
请参阅图19,图19是本申请实施例提供的一种通信装置的结构示意图。该通信装置可以为第一设备,也可以为第一设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以为能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。如图19所示,该通信装置1900,至少包括:建立单元1901、切换单元1902、收发单元1903和处理单元1904;其中:
建立单元1901,用于和第二设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;
切换单元1902,用于从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式;
收发单元1903,用于与所述第二设备进行通信。
在一个实施方式中,在满足第一条件的情况下,所述切换单元1902从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,所述第一条件包括以下一项或多项:所述第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者所述第一设 备与所述第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。
在一个实施方式中,第一运行模式对应第一带宽,所述第二运行模式对应第二带宽。
在一个实施方式中,第二设备工作在第三运行模式,所述第三运行模式对应第三带宽。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽,所述第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
在一个实施方式中,所述切换单元1902从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,具体用于:生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧;从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
在一个实施方式中,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903还用于在当前TXOP前向所述第二设备发送第七帧,所述第七帧用于指示所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式的切换时间;
所述收发单元1903,还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第八帧,所述第八帧用于响应所述第七帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903向所述第二设备发送第一帧,具体用于:根据所述第五帧中的TXOP时长评估所述第二设备侧待传输数据的数据量,在所述第二设备侧待传输数据的数据量大于或等于第四阈值的情况下,在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903向所述第二设备发送第一帧,具体用于:在所述第五帧中的TXOP时长指示的时间超过预设门限的情况下,在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903还用于向所述第二设备发送第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第九帧,所述第九帧用于所述第二设备向一个或多个第一设备传输数据;
所述收发单元1903还用于向所述第二设备发送第十帧,所述第十帧用于响应所述第九帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903还用于在所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式期间,接收来自所述第二设备的数据。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903还用于向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第一数值的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:在所述第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间大于所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在一个实施方式中,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第二帧为请求发送RTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第三帧为ACK帧。
在一个实施方式中,第五帧为RTS帧。
在一个实施方式中,该通信装置还包括:
处理单元1904,用于预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据;
根据所述第一字段选择对应的PHY层模块校准数据,配置PHY层寄存器。
在一个实施方式中,所述处理单元1904预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据,具体用于:预存第一带宽运行模式的PHY层校准数据,所述第一带宽为大于或等于第一阈值的带宽;
所述收发单元1903,还用于在信道切换后采用小于所述第一带宽的信号带宽收发信号。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元1903还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
有关上述建立单元1901、切换单元1902、收发单元1903和处理单元1904更详细的描述可以直接参考上述图4-图18所示的方法实施例中第一设备的相关描述,这里不加赘述。
请参阅图20,图20是本申请实施例提供的另一种通信装置的结构示意图。该通信装置可以为第二设备,也可以为第二设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以为能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。如图20所示,该通信装置2000,至少包括:建立单元2001、收发单元2002和处理单元2003;其中:
建立单元2001,用于和第一设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;
收发单元2002,用于与基于第二运行模式的所述第一设备进行通信。
在一个实施方式中,在满足第一条件的情况下,所述收发单元2002与基于第二运行模式的所述第一设备进行通信,所述第一条件包括以下一项或多项:所述第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者所述第一设备与所述第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一运行模式对应第一带宽,所述第二运行模式对应第二带宽。
在一个实施方式中,所述第二设备工作在第三运行模式,所述第三运行模式对应第三带宽。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽,所述第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于接收来自所述第一设备的第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于向所述第一设备发送第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
在一个实施方式中,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002向所述第一设备发送第二帧,具体用于:在所述第二设备的待传输数据量大于或等于第二阈值或待传输数据的所需传输时间大于或等于第三阈值的情况下,向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于:
在当前TXOP前接收来自第一设备的第七帧,所述第七帧用于指示所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式的切换时间;
向所述第一设备发送第八帧,所述第八帧用于响应所述第七帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于向所述第一设备发送第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于向所述第一设备发送第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于:
向所述第一设备发送第九帧,所述第九帧用于所述第二设备向一个或多个第一设备传输数据;
接收来自所述第一设备的第十帧,所述第十帧用于响应所述第九帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于在接收到来自一个或多个第一设备的第一帧或者在预设时间内未接收到来自一个或多个第一设备的第一帧的情况下,向所述一个或多个第一设备发送数据。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于在所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式期间,向所述第一设备发送数据。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第三帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第二数值的情况下,在所述运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间后向所述第一设备下发数据。
在一个实施方式中,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第三帧为ACK帧。
在一个实施方式中,第五帧为RTS帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述收发单元2002还用于向所述第一设备发送第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
有关上述建立单元2001、收发单元2002和处理单元2003更详细的描述可以直接参考上述图4-图18所示的方法实施例中第一设备的相关描述,这里不加赘述。
请参阅图21,图21是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信装置的结构示意图。该通信装置可以为第一设备,也可以为第一设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以为能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。如图21所示,该通信装置2100,至少包括:生成单元2101、收发单元2102和处理单元2103;其中:
生成单元2101,用于生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;
收发单元2102,用于向第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
在一个实施方式中,该通信装置2100还包括:
收发单元2102,用于接收来自所述第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式协商的参数。
在一个实施方式中,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
在一个实施方式中,收发单元2102还用于:接收来自所述第二设备的第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据;
收发单元2102向所述第二设备发送第一帧,具体用于:
根据所述第五帧评估所述第二设备侧待传输的数据量,在TXOP大于或等于第四阈值的情况下,在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在一个实施方式中,收发单元2102向所述第二设备发送第一帧,具体用于:
在第五帧中的TXOP时长(duration)指示的时间超过预设门限时,在当前TXOP内向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在一个实施方式中,收发单元2102还用于:向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
在一个实施方式中,收发单元2102向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第一值的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在一个实施方式中,收发单元2102向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
在所述第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间大于所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在一个实施方式中,收发单元2102向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在一个实施方式中,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第三帧为ACK帧。
在一个实施方式中,第五帧为RTS帧。
在一个实施方式中,该通信装置2100还包括:
处理单元2103用于预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据;
处理单元2103,还用于根据所述第一字段选择对应的PHY层模块校准数据,配置PHY层寄存器。
在一个实施方式中,处理单元2103预存不同运行模式下PHY层模块校准数据,具体用于:预存第一带宽运行模式的PHY层校准数据,所述第一带宽为大于或等于第一阈值的带宽;
收发单元2102,还用于在信道切换后采用小于所述第一带宽的信号带宽收发信号。
在一个实施方式中,收发单元2102,还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示 TXOP结束。
有关上述生成单元2101、收发单元2102和处理单元2103更详细的描述可以直接参考上述图4-图18所示的方法实施例中第一设备的相关描述,这里不加赘述。
请参阅图22,图22是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信装置的结构示意图。该通信装置可以为第二设备,也可以为第二设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以为能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。如图22所示,该通信装置2200,至少包括:接收单元2201、生成单元2202和发送单元2203;其中:
接收单元2201,用于接收来自第一设备的第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
在一个实施方式中,该通信装置2200还包括:
生成单元2202,用于生成第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数;
发送单元2203,用于向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2203向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧,具体用于:
在所述第二设备的待传输数据量大于或等于第二阈值或待传输数据的所需传输时间大于或等于第三阈值的情况下,向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2203还用于:向所述第一设备发送第五帧,所述第五帧用于请求所述第二设备向所述第一设备传输数据。
在一个实施方式中,接收单元2201还用于:接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2203还用于:接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第三帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2203还用于:在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第二数值的情况下,在所述运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间后向所述第一设备下发数据。
在一个实施方式中,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第三帧为ACK帧。
在一个实施方式中,第五帧为RTS帧。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2203还用于:向所述第一设备发送第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示当前TXOP结束。
有关上述接收单元2201、生成单元2202和发送单元2203更详细的描述可以直接参考上述图4-图18所示的方法实施例中第二设备的相关描述,这里不加赘述。
请参阅图23,图23是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信装置的结构示意图。该通信装置可以为第一设备,也可以为第一设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以为能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。如图23所示,该通信装置2300,至少包括:接收单元2301、生成单元2302和发送单元2303;其中:
接收单元2301,用于接收来自第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
在一个实施方式中,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
在一个实施方式中,该通信装置2300还包括:
生成单元2302,用于生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;
发送单元2303,用于向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2303还用于向所述第二设备发送第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2303还用于向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2303向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第一值的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2303向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
在所述第一设备的运行模式切换持续时间大于所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间的情况下,在完成运行模式切换后,向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2303向所述第二设备发送第三帧,具体用于:
选择原信号带宽或切换后的信号带宽向所述第二设备发送所述第三帧。
在一个实施方式中,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第三帧为ACK帧。
在一个实施方式中,第六帧为CTS帧。
在一个实施方式中,接收单元2301,还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
有关上述接收单元2301、生成单元2302和发送单元2303更详细的描述可以直接参考上述图4-图18所示的方法实施例中第一设备的相关描述,这里不加赘述。
请参阅图24,图24是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信装置的结构示意图。该通信装置可以为第二设备,也可以为第二设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以为能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。如图24所示,该通信装置2400,至少包括:生成单元2401、发送单元2402和接收单元2403;其中:
生成单元2401,用于生成第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数;
发送单元2402,用于向第一设备发送所述第二帧。
在一个实施方式中,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2402向第一设备发送所述第二帧,具体用于:
在所述第二设备的待传输数据量大于或等于第二阈值或待传输数据的所需传输时间大于或等于第三阈值的情况下,向所述第一设备发送所述第二帧。
在一个实施方式中,该通信装置2400还包括:
接收单元2403,用于接收来自所述第一设备的第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
在一个实施方式中,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
在一个实施方式中,接收单元2403还用于接收来自所述第一设备的第六帧,所述第六帧用于响应所述第二帧。
在一个实施方式中,接收单元2403还用于接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2402,还用于在接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第三帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2402,还用于在所述第一字段中的运行模式切换持续时间指示为第二数值的情况下,在所述运行模式切换持续时间指示的时间后向所述第一设备下发数据。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2402,还用于接收到来自所述第一设备的所述第六帧后,向所述第一设备下发数据。
在一个实施方式中,第一帧为CTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第二帧为RTS帧或触发帧。
在一个实施方式中,第三帧为ACK帧。
在一个实施方式中,第六帧为CTS帧。
在一个实施方式中,发送单元2402还用于向所述第一设备发送第四帧,所述第四帧用于指示TXOP结束。
有关上述生成单元2401、发送单元2402和接收单元2403更详细的描述可以直接参考上述图4-图18所示的方法实施例中第二设备的相关描述,这里不加赘述。
请参阅图25,图25是本申请实施例提供的又一种通信装置的结构示意图。如图25所示,该通信装置2500可以包括一个或多个处理器2501,处理器2501也可以称为处理单元,可以实现一定的控制功能。处理器2501可以是通用处理器或者专用处理器等。例如可以是基带处理器或中央处理器。基带处理器可以用于对通信协议以及通信数据进行处理,中央处理器可以用于对通信装置(如,基站、基带芯片,终端、终端芯片,DU或CU等)进行控制,执行软件程序,处理软件程序的数据。
在一种可选的设计中,处理器2501也可以存有指令2503,所述指令2503可以被所述处理器运行,使得所述通信装置2500执行上述方法实施例中描述的方法。
在另一种可选的设计中,处理器2501中可以包括用于实现接收和发送功能的收发单元。例如该收发单元可以是收发电路,或者是接口,或者是接口电路,或者是通信接口。用于实现接收和发送功能的收发电路、接口或接口电路可以是分开的,也可以集成在一起。上述收发电路、接口或接口电路可以用于代码/数据的读写,或者,上述收发电路、接口或接口电路可以用于信号的传输或传递。
在又一种可能的设计中,通信装置2500可以包括电路,所述电路可以实现前述方法实施例中发送或接收或者通信的功能。
可选的,所述通信装置2500中可以包括一个或多个存储器2502,其上可以存有指令2504,所述指令2504可在所述处理器上被运行,使得所述通信装置2500执行上述方法实施例中描述的方法。可选的,所述存储器中还可以存储有数据。可选的,处理器中也可以存储指令和/或数据。所述处理器和存储器可以单独设置,也可以集成在一起。例如,上述方法实施例中所描述的对应关系可以存储在存储器中,或者存储在处理器中。
可选的,所述通信装置2500还可以包括收发器2505和/或天线2506。所述处理器2501可以称为处理单元,对所述通信装置2500进行控制。所述收发器2505可以称为收发单元、收发机、收发电路、收发装置或收发模块等,用于实现收发功能。
可选的,本申请实施例中的通信装置2500可以用于执行本申请实施例中图4-图18描述的方法。
在一个实施例中,该通信装置2500可以应用于第一设备,也可以应用于第一设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第一设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。存储器2502中存储的计算机程序指令被执行时,该处理器2501用于执行上述实施例中建立单元1901、切换单元1902和处理单元1904执行的操作,或者用于执行上述实施例中生成单元2101和处理单元2103执行的操作,或者用于执行上述实施例中生成单元2302执行的操作,收发器2505用于执行上述实施例中收发单元1903执行的操作,或者用于执行上述实施例中收发单元2102执行的操作,或者用于执行上述实施例中接收单元2301和发送单元2303执行的操作,收发器2505还用于向该通信装置之外的其它通信装置发送信息。上述第一设备或者第一设备内的模块还可以用于执行上述图4-图18方法实施例中第一设备执行的各种方法,不再赘述。
在一个实施例中,该通信装置2500可以应用于第二设备,也可以应用于第二设备中的模块(例如,芯片或处理器),还可以应用于能实现全部或部分第二设备功能的逻辑模块或软件。存储器2502中存储的计算机程序指令被执行时,该处理器2501用于执行上述实施例中建立单元2001和处理单元2003,或者用于执行上述实施例中生成单元2202执行的操作,或者用于执行上述实施例中生成单元2401执行的操作,收发器2505用于执行上述实施例中收发单元2002执行的操作,或者用于执行上述实施例中接收单元2201和发送单元2203执行的操作,或者用于执行上述实施例中发送单元2402和接收单元2403执行的操作,收发器2505还用于向该通信装置之外的其它通信装置发送信息。上述第二设备或者第二设备内的模块还可以用于执行上述图4-图18方法实施例中第二设备执行的各种方法,不再赘述。
本申请中描述的处理器和收发器可实现在集成电路(integrated circuit,IC)、模拟IC、射频集成电路(radiofrequencyinterfacechip,RFIC)、混合信号IC、专用集成电路(application specific integrated circuit,ASIC)、印刷电路板(printed circuit board,PCB)、电子设备等上。该处理器和收发器也可以用各种IC工艺技术来制造,例如互补金属氧化物半导体(complementary metal oxide semiconductor,CMOS)、N型金属 氧化物半导体(nMetal-oxide-semiconductor,NMOS)、P型金属氧化物半导体(positive channel metal oxide semiconductor,PMOS)、双极结型晶体管(Bipolar Junction Transistor,BJT)、双极CMOS(BiCMOS)、硅锗(SiGe)、砷化镓(GaAs)等。
以上实施例描述中的装置可以是第一设备或者第二设备,但本申请中描述的装置的范围并不限于此,而且装置的结构可以不受图25的限制。装置可以是独立的设备或者可以是较大设备的一部分。例如所述装置可以是:
(1)独立的集成电路IC,或芯片,或芯片系统或子系统;
(2)具有一个或多个IC的集合,可选的,该IC集合也可以包括用于存储数据和/或指令的存储部件;
(3)ASIC,例如调制解调器(MSM);
(4)可嵌入在其他设备内的模块;
(5)接收机、终端、智能终端、蜂窝电话、无线设备、手持机、移动单元、车载设备、网络设备、云设备、人工智能设备、机器设备、家居设备、医疗设备、工业设备等等;
(6)其他等等。
本申请实施例还提供一种计算机可读存储介质,其上存储有计算机程序,该程序被处理器执行时可以实现上述方法实施例提供的通信方法中与第一设备相关的流程。
本申请实施例还提供一种计算机可读存储介质,其上存储有计算机程序,该程序被处理器执行时可以实现上述方法实施例提供的通信方法中与第二设备相关的流程。
本申请实施例还提供了一种计算机程序产品,当其在计算机或处理器上运行时,使得计算机或处理器执行上述任一个通信方法中的一个或多个步骤。上述所涉及的设备的各组成模块如果以软件功能单元的形式实现并作为独立的产品销售或使用时,可以存储在所述计算机可读取存储介质中。
本申请实施例还提供一种芯片系统,包括至少一个处理器和通信接口,所述通信接口和所述至少一个处理器通过线路互联,所述至少一个处理器用于运行计算机程序或指令,以执行包括上述图4-图18对应的方法实施例中记载的任意一种的部分或全部步骤。该芯片系统,可以由芯片构成,也可以包含芯片和其他分立器件。
本申请实施例还公开一种通信系统,该系统包括第一设备和第二设备,具体描述可以参考图4-图18所示的通信方法。
应理解,本申请实施例中提及的存储器可以是易失性存储器或非易失性存储器,或可包括易失性和非易失性存储器两者。其中,非易失性存储器可以是硬盘(hard disk drive,HDD)、固态硬盘(solid-state drive,SSD)、只读存储器(read-only memory,ROM)、可编程只读存储器(programmable ROM,PROM)、可擦除可编程只读存储器(erasable PROM,EPROM)、电可擦除可编程只读存储器(electrically EPROM,EEPROM)或闪存。易失性存储器可以是随机存取存储器(random access memory,RAM),其用作外部高速缓存。通过示例性但不是限制性说明,许多形式的RAM可用,例如静态随机存取存储器(static rAM,SRAM)、动态随机存取存储器(dynamic RAM,DRAM)、同步动态随机存取存储器(synchronous dRAM,SDRAM)、双倍数据速率同步动态随机存取存储器(double data rate SDRAM,DDR SDRAM)、增强型同步动态随机存取存储器(enhanced SDRAM,ESDRAM)、同步连接动态随机存取存储器(synchlink DRAM,SLDRAM)和直接内存总线随机存取存储器(direct rambus RAM,DR RAM)。存储器是能够用于携带或存储具有指令或数据结构形式的期望的程序代码并能够由计算机存取的任何其他介质,但不限于此。本申请实施例中的存储器还可以是电路或者其它任意能够实现存储功能的装置,用于存储程序指令和/或数据。
还应理解,本申请实施例中提及的处理器可以是中央处理单元(central processing unit,CPU),还可以是其他通用处理器、数字信号处理器(digital signal processor,DSP)、专用集成电路(application specific integrated circuit,ASIC)、现成可编程门阵列(field programmable gate array,FPGA)或者其他可编程逻辑器件、分立门或者晶体管逻辑器件、分立硬件组件等。通用处理器可以是微处理器或者该处理器也可以是任何常规的处理器等。
需要说明的是,当处理器为通用处理器、DSP、ASIC、FPGA或者其他可编程逻辑器件、分立门或者晶体管逻辑器件、分立硬件组件时,存储器(存储模块)集成在处理器中。
应注意,本文描述的存储器旨在包括但不限于这些和任意其它适合类型的存储器。
应理解,在本申请的各种实施例中,上述各过程的序号的大小并不意味着执行顺序的先后,各过程的 执行顺序应以其功能和内在逻辑确定,而不应对本申请实施例的实施过程构成任何限定。
本领域普通技术人员可以意识到,结合本文中所提供的实施例描述的各示例的单元及算法步骤,能够以电子硬件、或者计算机软件和电子硬件的结合来实现。这些功能究竟以硬件还是软件方式来执行,取决于技术方案的特定应用和设计约束条件。专业技术人员可以对每个特定的应用来使用不同方法来实现所描述的功能,但是这种实现不应认为超出本申请的范围。
所属领域的技术人员可以清楚地了解到,为描述的方便和简洁,上述描述的系统、装置和单元的具体工作过程,可以参考前述方法实施例中的对应过程,在此不再赘述。
在本申请所提供的几个实施例中,应该理解到,所揭露的系统、装置和方法,可以通过其它的方式实现。例如,以上所描述的装置实施例仅仅是示意性的,例如,所述单元的划分,仅仅为一种逻辑功能划分,实际实现时可以有另外的划分方式,例如多个单元或组件可以结合或者可以集成到另一个系统,或一些特征可以忽略,或不执行。另一点,所显示或讨论的相互之间的耦合或直接耦合或通信连接可以是通过一些接口,装置或单元的间接耦合或通信连接,可以是电性,机械或其它的形式。
所述作为分离部件说明的单元可以是或者也可以不是物理上分开的,作为单元显示的部件可以是或者也可以不是物理单元,即可以位于一个地方,或者也可以分布到多个网络单元上。可以根据实际的需要选择其中的部分或者全部单元来实现本实施例方案的目的。
另外,在本申请各个实施例中的各功能单元可以集成在一个处理单元中,也可以是各个单元单独物理存在,也可以两个或两个以上单元集成在一个单元中。
所述功能如果以软件功能单元的形式实现并作为独立的产品销售或使用时,可以存储在一个计算机可读取存储介质中。基于这样的理解,本申请的技术方案本质上或者说对技术做出贡献的部分或者该技术方案的部分可以以软件产品的形式体现出来,该计算机软件产品存储在一个存储介质中,包括若干指令用以使得一台计算机设备(可以是个人计算机,服务器,或者网络设备等)执行本申请各个实施例所述方法的全部或部分步骤。而前述的存储介质包括:U盘、移动硬盘、ROM、RAM、磁碟或者光盘等各种可以存储程序代码的介质。
本申请实施例方法中的步骤可以根据实际需要进行顺序调整、合并和删减。
本申请实施例装置中的模块/单元可以根据实际需要进行合并、划分和删减。
以上所述,以上实施例仅用以说明本申请的技术方案,而非对其限制;尽管参照前述实施例对本申请进行了详细的说明,本领域的普通技术人员应当理解:其依然可以对前述各实施例所记载的技术方案进行修改,或者对其中部分技术特征进行等同替换;而这些修改或者替换,并不使相应技术方案的本质脱离本申请各实施例技术方案的范围。

Claims (50)

  1. 一种通信方法,其特征在于,包括:
    第一设备和第二设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;
    所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,与所述第二设备进行通信。
  2. 根据权利要求1所述的方法,其特征在于,在满足第一条件的情况下,所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,所述第一条件包括以下一项或多项:
    所述第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者
    所述第一设备与所述第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。
  3. 根据权利要求1或2所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一运行模式对应第一带宽,所述第二运行模式对应第二带宽。
  4. 根据权利要求3所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二设备工作在第三运行模式,所述第三运行模式对应第三带宽。
  5. 根据权利要求4所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽,所述第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
  6. 根据权利要求1-5任一所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式包括:
    所述第一设备生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;
    所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧;
    所述第一设备从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式。
  7. 根据权利要求6所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
  8. 根据权利要求7所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
  9. 根据权利要求6-8任一所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    所述第一设备接收来自所述第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
  10. 根据权利要求9所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
  11. 根据权利要求6-10任一所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    所述第一设备向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
  12. 一种通信方法,其特征在于,包括:
    第二设备和第一设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;
    所述第二设备与基于第二运行模式的所述第一设备进行通信。
  13. 根据权利要求12所述的方法,其特征在于,在满足第一条件的情况下,所述第二设备与基于第二运行模式的所述第一设备进行通信,所述第一条件包括以下一项或多项:
    所述第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者
    所述第一设备与所述第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。
  14. 根据权利要求12或13所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一运行模式对应第一带宽,所述第二运行模式对应第二带宽。
  15. 根据权利要求14所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二设备工作在第三运行模式,所述第三运行模式对应第三带宽。
  16. 根据权利要求15所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽,所述第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
  17. 根据权利要求12-16任一所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    所述第二设备接收来自所述第一设备的第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
  18. 根据权利要求17所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
  19. 根据权利要求18所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
  20. 根据权利要求17-19任一所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    所述第二设备向所述第一设备发送第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式 协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
  21. 根据权利要求20所述的方法,其特征在于,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
  22. 根据权利要求17-21任一所述的方法,其特征在于,所述方法还包括:
    所述第二设备接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
  23. 一种通信方法,其特征在于,所述通信方法包括如权利要求1-11任一项所述的方法和如权利要求12-22任一项所述的方法。
  24. 一种通信装置,其特征在于,包括:
    建立单元,用于和第二设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;
    切换单元,用于从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式;
    收发单元,用于与所述第二设备进行通信。
  25. 根据权利要求24所述的装置,其特征在于,在满足第一条件的情况下,所述切换单元从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,所述第一条件包括以下一项或多项:所述第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者所述第一设备与所述第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。
  26. 根据权利要求24或25所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第一运行模式对应第一带宽,所述第二运行模式对应第二带宽。
  27. 根据权利要求26所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第二设备工作在第三运行模式,所述第三运行模式对应第三带宽。
  28. 根据权利要求27所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽,所述第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
  29. 根据权利要求24-28任一所述的装置,其特征在于,所述切换单元从所述第一运行模式切换到第二运行模式,具体用于:生成第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数;向所述第二设备发送所述第一帧;从所述第一运行模式切换到所述第二运行模式。
  30. 根据权利要求29所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
  31. 根据权利要求30所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
  32. 根据权利要求29-31任一所述的装置,其特征在于,所述收发单元还用于接收来自所述第二设备的第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
  33. 根据权利要求32所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
  34. 根据权利要求29-33任一所述的装置,其特征在于,所述收发单元还用于向所述第二设备发送第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
  35. 一种通信装置,其特征在于,包括:
    建立单元,用于和第一设备建立无线通信链路,所述第一设备工作在第一运行模式;
    收发单元,用于与基于第二运行模式的所述第一设备进行通信。
  36. 根据权利要求35所述的装置,其特征在于,在满足第一条件的情况下,所述收发单元与基于第二运行模式的所述第一设备进行通信,所述第一条件包括以下一项或多项:所述第一设备从侦听状态到数据传输状态;或者所述第一设备与所述第二设备待传输的数据量从小于或等于第一阈值到大于所述第一阈值。
  37. 根据权利要求35或36所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第一运行模式对应第一带宽,所述第二运行模式对应第二带宽。
  38. 根据权利要求37所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第二设备工作在第三运行模式,所述第三运行模式对应第三带宽。
  39. 根据权利要求38所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第一带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽,所述第二带宽小于或等于所述第三带宽。
  40. 根据权利要求35-39任一所述的装置,其特征在于,所述收发单元还用于接收来自所述第一设备的第一帧,所述第一帧包括第一字段,所述第一字段包含运行模式参数。
  41. 根据权利要求40所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第一字段包括运行模式切换持续时间指示。
  42. 根据权利要求41所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第一字段还包括信号带宽。
  43. 根据权利要求40-42任一所述的装置,其特征在于,所述收发单元还用于向所述第一设备发送第二帧,所述第二帧包括第二字段,所述第二帧用于发起运行模式协商,所述第二字段用于推荐运行模式参数。
  44. 根据权利要求43所述的装置,其特征在于,所述第二字段包括运行模式推荐指示和/或运行模式协商指示。
  45. 根据权利要求40-44任一所述的装置,其特征在于,所述收发单元还用于接收来自所述第一设备的第三帧,所述第三帧用于指示运行模式切换完成。
  46. 一种通信装置,其特征在于,包括处理器、存储器、输入接口和输出接口,所述输入接口用于接收来自所述通信装置之外的其它通信装置的信息,所述输出接口用于向所述通信装置之外的其它通信装置输出信息,当所述存储器中存储的存储计算机程序被所述处理器调用时,使得如权利要求1-11任意一项所述的方法被实现,或者如权利要求12-22任意一项所述的方法被实现。
  47. 一种计算机可读存储介质,其特征在于,所述计算机可读存储介质中存储有计算机程序或计算机指令,当所述计算机程序或计算机指令被处理器执行时,以支持第一设备实现如权利要求1-11任意一项所述的方法,或者以支持第二设备实现如权利要求12-22任意一项所述的方法。
  48. 一种包含程序指令的计算机程序产品,当所述程序指令在计算机上运行时,使得如权利要求1-11任意一项所述的方法被实现,或者如权利要求12-22任意一项所述的方法被实现。
  49. 一种芯片系统,其特征在于,包括至少一个处理器、存储器和接口电路,所述存储器、所述接口电路和所述至少一个处理器通过线路互联,所述至少一个存储器中存储有指令;所述指令被所述处理器执行时,以支持第一设备实现如权利要求1-11任意一项所述的方法,或者支持第二设备实现如权利要求12-22任意一项所述的方法。
  50. 一种通信系统,其特征在于,包括第一设备和第二设备,所述第一设备用于执行根据权利要求1-11任一项所述的方法,所述第二设备用于执行根据权利要求12-22任一项所述的方法。
PCT/CN2023/127900 2022-11-26 2023-10-30 一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质 WO2024109468A1 (zh)

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
CN202211495298.9 2022-11-26
CN202211495298.9A CN118102334A (zh) 2022-11-26 2022-11-26 一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2024109468A1 true WO2024109468A1 (zh) 2024-05-30

Family

ID=91150602

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/CN2023/127900 WO2024109468A1 (zh) 2022-11-26 2023-10-30 一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质

Country Status (2)

Country Link
CN (1) CN118102334A (zh)
WO (1) WO2024109468A1 (zh)

Citations (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20170127269A1 (en) * 2015-10-29 2017-05-04 Lg Electronics Inc. Method and apparatus for changing operating mode in wireless local area network system
US20170367096A1 (en) * 2016-06-21 2017-12-21 Lg Electronics Inc. Method and apparatus for changing operating mode in wireless local area network system
CN109286967A (zh) * 2017-07-21 2019-01-29 华为技术有限公司 无线传输方法、装置及设备
CN113365327A (zh) * 2020-03-06 2021-09-07 华为技术有限公司 一种应用于多链路通信中的节能方法和通信装置
CN113518388A (zh) * 2020-04-10 2021-10-19 华为技术有限公司 操作模式的协商方法、发起端、接收端、芯片系统、介质

Patent Citations (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20170127269A1 (en) * 2015-10-29 2017-05-04 Lg Electronics Inc. Method and apparatus for changing operating mode in wireless local area network system
US20170367096A1 (en) * 2016-06-21 2017-12-21 Lg Electronics Inc. Method and apparatus for changing operating mode in wireless local area network system
CN109286967A (zh) * 2017-07-21 2019-01-29 华为技术有限公司 无线传输方法、装置及设备
CN113365327A (zh) * 2020-03-06 2021-09-07 华为技术有限公司 一种应用于多链路通信中的节能方法和通信装置
CN113518388A (zh) * 2020-04-10 2021-10-19 华为技术有限公司 操作模式的协商方法、发起端、接收端、芯片系统、介质

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
CN118102334A (zh) 2024-05-28

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US9455808B2 (en) Wireless communication system with coordinated multipoint operation and methods for use therewith
US11070953B2 (en) Triggered wireless access protocol
CN107113782A (zh) 用于数字通信中避免干扰的系统和方法
US20220104261A1 (en) Method and apparatus for multi-link communications
WO2022012561A1 (zh) 数据传输方法及装置
JP2023549790A (ja) Ppdu内の空間再使用パラメータフィールドを決定する方法、および関連装置
CN108141892A (zh) 用于选择用于多用户传输的增强型分布式信道接入参数的方法和装置
US20230209518A1 (en) Communication method and apparatus
JP2024056907A (ja) 通信装置、通信方法、およびプログラム
US11963083B2 (en) Communication method and apparatus
US20230354276A1 (en) Time resource allocation and receiving method and related apparatus
JP2023086978A (ja) 通信装置及びその通信方法、情報処理装置及びその制御方法、及び、プログラム
WO2024109468A1 (zh) 一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质
WO2022127377A1 (zh) 空间复用参数指示和空间复用参数字段的确定方法及装置
KR20240064024A (ko) 신호 전송 방법, 신호 수신 방법, 및 통신 장치
US20150350382A1 (en) Methods and systems for dual channel information
US20230284215A1 (en) Method and apparatus for traffic identifier-based uplink triggering operation
WO2024078255A1 (zh) 一种通信方法、装置及计算机可读存储介质
WO2024174970A1 (zh) 多链路通信方法及装置
WO2023160331A1 (zh) 一种天线模式切换方法及相关装置
TWI854174B (zh) 空間複用參數指示和空間複用參數欄位的確定方法及裝置
TWI839839B (zh) 實體層協定資料單元傳輸方法、通信裝置、電腦可讀儲存介質、電腦程式產品、晶片及通信系統
US20240147363A1 (en) Low power listening mode for stations of a wireless network
WO2024120531A1 (zh) 多链路通信方法及装置
WO2024169904A1 (zh) 一种感知测量的方法及通信装置

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 23893559

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1